jtag/jlink: switch to command 'adapter serial'
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, jlink, kitprog, presto, vsllink, xds110.
2375 The following adapters have their own command to specify the serial string:
2376 hla, st-link.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @section Interface Drivers
2380
2381 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2382 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2383 available at run time.
2384
2385 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2386 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2387 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2388 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2389
2390 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2391 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2392 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2396 Displays status of RTCK option.
2397 Optionally sets that option first.
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2402 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2403 This has one driver-specific command:
2404
2405 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2406 Logs some status
2407 @end deffn
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2411 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2412 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2413 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2414 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2415 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2419 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2420 or v2 (USB bulk).
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2423 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2424 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2425 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2426 @example
2427 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2428 @end example
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2432 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2433
2434 @itemize @minus
2435 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2436 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2437 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2438 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2439 @end itemize
2440 @end deffn
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2443 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2444 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2445 interface string or for user class interface.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2449 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2450 @end deffn
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2454 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2458 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2462 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2463 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2464
2465 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2466 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2467
2468 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2469 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2470
2471 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2472 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2473 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2474 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2475 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2476 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2477
2478 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2479 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2480 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2481 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2482 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2483
2484 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2485 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2486 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2487 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2488
2489 @itemize @minus
2490 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2491 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2493 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2494 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2495 switching data and direction as necessary
2496 @end itemize
2497
2498 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2499 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2502 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2503 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2504 @example
2505 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2506 @end example
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2510 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2511 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2512 during device selection.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2516 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2517 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2521 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2522 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2523 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2524 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2525 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2526 and initially asserted reset signals.
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2530 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2531 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2532 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2533 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2534 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2535 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2536 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2537 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2538 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2539 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2540
2541 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2542 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2543 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2544 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2545 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2546 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2547
2548 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2549 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2550 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2551 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2552 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2553 are always driven by the FTDI.
2554
2555 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2556 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2557 @var{name}.
2558 @end deffn
2559
2560 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2561 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2562 @itemize @minus
2563 @item @option{0}, drive low
2564 @item @option{1}, drive high
2565 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2566 @end itemize
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2570 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2574 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2575
2576 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2577 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2578 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2579 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2580 @itemize @minus
2581 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2582 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2583 @end itemize
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2587 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2588
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2592 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2593 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2594 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2595
2596 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2597 @itemize @minus
2598 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2599 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2600 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2601 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2602 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2603 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2604 @end itemize
2605
2606 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2607 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2608 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2609 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2610 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2611 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2612 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2613 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2614
2615 FT232R
2616 @itemize @minus
2617 @item bit 7 - RI
2618 @item bit 6 - DCD
2619 @item bit 5 - DSR
2620 @item bit 4 - DTR
2621 @item bit 3 - CTS
2622 @item bit 2 - RTS
2623 @item bit 1 - RXD
2624 @item bit 0 - TXD
2625 @end itemize
2626
2627 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2628 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2631 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2632 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2636 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2637 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2641 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2645 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2649 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2653 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2654 @end deffn
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2657 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2661 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2665 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2666 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2667 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2668 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2669 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2670 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2671 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2672 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2673 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2679 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2680 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2681 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2682
2683 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2684 processors which are being simulated.
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2687 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2688 sockets instead of TCP.
2689 @end deffn
2690
2691 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2692 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2693 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2697 something like:
2698
2699 @example
2700 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2701 remote_bitbang port 3335
2702 remote_bitbang host foobar
2703 @end example
2704
2705 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2706 named mysocket:
2707
2708 @example
2709 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2710 remote_bitbang port 0
2711 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2712 @end example
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2716 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2717 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2718 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2721 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2722 default values are used.
2723 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2724 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2725 @example
2726 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2727 @end example
2728 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2729 @example
2730 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2735 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2736 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2737 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2738 target board.
2739
2740 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2741 @example
2742 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2743 reset_config srst_only
2744 @end example
2745 @end deffn
2746
2747 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2748 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2749 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2750 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2751 @end deffn
2752
2753 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2754 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2755 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2761 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2762 This has one driver-specific command:
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2765 Display either the address of the I/O port
2766 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2767 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2768 This is a write-once setting.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @end deffn
2771
2772 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2773 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2774 transports.
2775
2776 @quotation Compatibility Note
2777 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2778 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2779 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2780 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2781 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2782 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2783 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2784 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2785 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2786 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2787 @end quotation
2788
2789 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2790 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2791 states.
2792 @end deffn
2793 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2794 Display free device internal memory.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2797 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2798 command version.
2799 @end deffn
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2801 Display the device configuration.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2804 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2805 power state.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2808 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2809 @end deffn
2810 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2811 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2812 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2813 IP configuration.
2814 @end deffn
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2816 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2817 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2820 Reset the current configuration.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2823 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2826 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2827 pairs.
2828
2829 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2830 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2831 @example
2832 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2833 @end example
2834 @end deffn
2835 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2836 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2837 pairs.
2838
2839 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2840 @example
2841 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2842 77a90000
2843 @end example
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2846 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2847 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2848 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2849 the serial number instead, if possible.
2850
2851 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @end deffn
2854
2855 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2856 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2857 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2858 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2859 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2860 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2861 configuration script.
2862
2863 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2864 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2865 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2866 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2867 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2868
2869 Known limitations:
2870 @itemize @bullet
2871 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2872 and 2.7 MHz.
2873 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2874 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2875 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2876 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2877 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2878 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2879 communications with the target.
2880 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2881 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2882 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2883 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2884 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2885 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2886 @end itemize
2887
2888 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2889 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2890 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2891 @end deffn
2892
2893 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2894 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2895 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2896 target as a side-effect.
2897 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2898 @end deffn
2899
2900 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2901 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2902 version, and target voltage.
2903 @end deffn
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2907 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2908 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2909 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2910 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2911
2912 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2913 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2914 This is a write-once setting.
2915 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2916
2917 @itemize @minus
2918 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2919 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2920 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2921 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2922 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2923 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2924 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2925 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2926 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2927 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2928 some versions of
2929 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2930 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2931 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2932 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2933 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2934 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2935 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2936 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2937 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2938 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2939 @end itemize
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2943 Display either the address of the I/O port
2944 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2945 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2946 This is a write-once setting.
2947
2948 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2949 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2950 you may encounter a problem.
2951 @end deffn
2952
2953 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2954 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2955 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2956 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2957 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2958 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2959
2960 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2961 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2962 @quotation Tip
2963 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2964 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2965 @example
2966 > parport toggling_time 1000
2967 > adapter speed 500
2968 @end example
2969 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2970 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2971 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2972 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2973 large set of samples.
2974 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2975 @example
2976 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2977 @end example
2978 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2979 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2980
2981 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2982 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2983 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2984 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2985 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
2986 be conservative.
2987 @end quotation
2988 @end deffn
2989
2990 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2991 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2992 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2993 @end deffn
2994
2995 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2996 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2997
2998 @example
2999 adapter driver parport
3000 parport port 0x278
3001 parport cable wiggler
3002 @end example
3003 @end deffn
3004
3005 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3006 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3007 @end deffn
3008
3009 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3010 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3011 @end deffn
3012
3013 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3014 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3015 @end deffn
3016
3017 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3018 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3019
3020 @quotation Note
3021 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3022 which are not currently documented here.
3023 @end quotation
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @anchor{hla_interface}
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3028 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3029 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3030 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3031
3032 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3033 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3034 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3035 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3036 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3037 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3038
3039 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3040 Currently Not Supported.
3041 @end deffn
3042
3043 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3044 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3045 @end deffn
3046
3047 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3048 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3049 @end deffn
3050
3051 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3052 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3053 @end deffn
3054
3055 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3056 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3057 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3058
3059 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3060 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3061 ST-LINK server software module}.
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3065 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3066 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3067 @end deffn
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3071 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3072 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3073 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3074 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3075
3076 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3077 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3078 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3079 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3080
3081 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3082 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3085 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3086 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3087
3088 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3089 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3090 ST-LINK server software module}.
3091
3092 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3093 @end deffn
3094
3095 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3096 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3100 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3101 @end deffn
3102
3103 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3104 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3105 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3106
3107 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3108 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3109 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3110 the target's supply voltage.
3111 @example
3112 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3113 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3114 @end example
3115 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3116 @example
3117 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3118 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3119 3.24891518738
3120 @end example
3121 @end deffn
3122 @end deffn
3123
3124 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3125 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3129 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3130 @end deffn
3131
3132 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3133 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3134 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3135 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3136 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3137
3138 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3139 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3140 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3141 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3145 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3146 version).
3147 @end deffn
3148 @end deffn
3149
3150 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3151 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3152 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3153 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3154 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3155
3156 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3157
3158 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3159 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3160
3161 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3162 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3163
3164 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3165
3166 @end deffn
3167 @end deffn
3168
3169 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3170 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3171 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3172
3173 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3174 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3175 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3176 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3177 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3178 configuration on exit.
3179
3180 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3181
3182 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3183 pinout.
3184
3185 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3186 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3187 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3188 individually.
3189 @end deffn
3190
3191 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3192 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3193 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3194 @end deffn
3195
3196 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3197 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3198 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3199 @end deffn
3200
3201 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3202 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3203 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3204 @end deffn
3205
3206 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3207 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3208 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3209 @end deffn
3210
3211 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3212 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3213 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3217 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3218 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3219 @end deffn
3220
3221 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3222 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3223 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3227 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3228 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3229 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3230 @end deffn
3231
3232 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3233 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3234 @end deffn
3235
3236 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3237 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3238 @end deffn
3239
3240 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3241 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3242 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3243 @end deffn
3244
3245 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3246 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3247 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3248 list can be found in the
3249 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3250 @end deffn
3251
3252 @end deffn
3253
3254 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3255 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3256 of the one which is most popular.
3257
3258 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3259
3260 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3261 pinout.
3262
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265
3266 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3267 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3268 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3269
3270 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273
3274 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3275 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3276 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3277
3278 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3279 @end deffn
3280
3281
3282 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3283 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3284 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3285
3286 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3287 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3288 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3289
3290 @itemize @minus
3291 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3292 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3293 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3294 @end itemize
3295 @end deffn
3296
3297 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3298 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3299 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3300 @end deffn
3301 @end deffn
3302
3303
3304 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3305 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3306 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3307 DPI server interface.
3308
3309 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3310 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3311 @end deffn
3312
3313 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3314 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3315 @end deffn
3316 @end deffn
3317
3318
3319 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3320
3321 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3322 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3323
3324 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3325 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3326
3327 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3328 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3329 @example
3330 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3331 @end example
3332 @end deffn
3333
3334 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3335 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3336 @example
3337 buspirate speed normal
3338 @end example
3339 @end deffn
3340
3341 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3342 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3343 @itemize @minus
3344 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3345 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3346 @end itemize
3347 For example:
3348 @example
3349 buspirate mode normal
3350 @end example
3351 @end deffn
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3354 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3355 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3356 For example:
3357 @example
3358 buspirate pullup 0
3359 @end example
3360 @end deffn
3361
3362 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3363 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3364 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3365 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3366 @example
3367 buspirate vreg 0
3368 @end example
3369 @end deffn
3370
3371 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3372 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3373 @end deffn
3374 @example
3375 buspirate led 1
3376 @end example
3377
3378 @end deffn
3379
3380
3381 @section Transport Configuration
3382 @cindex Transport
3383 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3384 and the debug adapter you are using,
3385 several transports may be available to
3386 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3387 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3388 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3389 version of OpenOCD.
3390 @end deffn
3391
3392 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3393 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3394
3395 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3396 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3397 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3398 adapter's driver).
3399
3400 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3401 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3402 supported by the debug adapter.
3403
3404 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3405 transport, if any.
3406 @end deffn
3407
3408 @subsection JTAG Transport
3409 @cindex JTAG
3410 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3411 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3412 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3413 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3414 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3415 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3416
3417 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3418 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3419 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3420 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3421 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3422
3423 @subsection SWD Transport
3424 @cindex SWD
3425 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3426 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3427 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3428 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3429 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3430 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3431 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3432
3433 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3434 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3435 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3436 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3437 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3438
3439 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3440 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3441 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3442 expected to change.
3443 @end deffn
3444
3445 @subsection SPI Transport
3446 @cindex SPI
3447 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3448 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3449 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3450 solution for flash programming.
3451
3452 @anchor{swimtransport}
3453 @subsection SWIM Transport
3454 @cindex SWIM
3455 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3456 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3457 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3458 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3459
3460 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3461
3462 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3463
3464 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3465 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3466 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3467 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3468 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3469
3470 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3471 @section JTAG Speed
3472 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3473 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3474 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3475 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3476 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3477 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3478 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3479 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3480 power management software that may be active.
3481
3482 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3483 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3484 target event handler.
3485 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3486 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3487 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3488 sets up those clocks).
3489 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3490 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3491 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3492 in the target config file.
3493 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3494 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3495 config file instead.
3496 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3497 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3498 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3499
3500 @example
3501 jtag_rclk 3000
3502 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3503 @end example
3504
3505 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3506 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3507 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3508 may not be the fastest solution.
3509
3510 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3511 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3512 which support adaptive clocking.
3513
3514 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3515 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3516 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3517 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3518 than the speed specified.
3519
3520 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3521 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3522 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3523 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3524
3525 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3526 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3527 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3528 JTAG clocking after setup.
3529 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3530 If the interface device can not
3531 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3532 @end deffn
3533
3534 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3535 @cindex adaptive clocking
3536 @cindex RTCK
3537 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3538 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3539 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3540 @example
3541 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3542 jtag_rclk 3000
3543 @end example
3544 @end defun
3545
3546 @node Reset Configuration
3547 @chapter Reset Configuration
3548 @cindex Reset Configuration
3549
3550 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3551 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3552 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3553 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3554 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3555 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3556 Please see the various board files for examples.
3557
3558 @quotation Note
3559 To maintainers and integrators:
3560 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3561 Normally the board configuration file
3562 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3563 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3564
3565 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3566 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3567 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3568 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3569 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3570 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3571 @end quotation
3572
3573 @section Types of Reset
3574
3575 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3576 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3577 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3578
3579 @itemize @bullet
3580 @item
3581 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3582 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3583 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3584 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3585 @item
3586 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3587 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3588 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3589 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3590 @item
3591 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3592 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3593 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3594 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3595 @item
3596 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3597 several other types of reset.
3598 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3599 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3600 There may be individual module resets.
3601 @end itemize
3602
3603 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3604 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3605 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3606 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3607 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3608 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3609 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3610 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3611 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3612
3613 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3614 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3615
3616 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3617 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3618 common issues are:
3619
3620 @itemize @bullet
3621
3622 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3623 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3624 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3625 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3626 when either of those signals is not connected.
3627 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3628 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3629 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3630 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3631
3632 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3633 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3634 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3635 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3636
3637 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3638 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3639 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3640 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3641 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3642 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3643 hardware debouncing.
3644 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3645 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3646
3647 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3648 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3649 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3650 to use push/pull output drivers.
3651 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3652 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3653 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3654 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3655
3656 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3657 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3658 issues (not limited to errata).
3659 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3660 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3661 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3662 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3663 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3664 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3665 @end itemize
3666
3667 There can also be other issues.
3668 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3669 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3670 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3671 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3672 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3673 Agreement (NDA).
3674
3675 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3676 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3677 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3678
3679 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3680 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3681
3682 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3683
3684 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3685 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3686 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3687 allowing it to be deasserted.
3688 @end deffn
3689
3690 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3691 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3692 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3693 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3694 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3695 @end deffn
3696
3697 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3698 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3699 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3700 allowing it to be deasserted.
3701 @end deffn
3702
3703 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3704 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3705 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3706 @end deffn
3707
3708 @anchor{reset_config}
3709 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3710 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3711 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3712 configuration scripts.
3713
3714 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3715 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3716 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3717 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3718 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3719 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3720 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3721 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3722
3723 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3724 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3725 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3726 -- may be specified at a time.
3727 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3728 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3729 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3730 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3731 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3732
3733 @itemize
3734 @item
3735 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3736 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3737 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3738 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3739 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3740
3741 @quotation Tip
3742 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3743 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3744 @end quotation
3745
3746 @item
3747 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3748 signal implementations.
3749 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3750 indicating everything behaves normally.
3751 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3752 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3753 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3754 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3755 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3756 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3757 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3758
3759 @item
3760 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3761 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3762 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3763 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3764 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3765 while SRST is asserted.
3766 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3767 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3768
3769 @item
3770 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3771 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3772 is required to use this option.
3773 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3774 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3775 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3776 be asserted before any target connection.
3777 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3778 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3779 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3780 @end itemize
3781
3782 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3783 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3784 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3785 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3786 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3787
3788 @itemize
3789 @item
3790 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3791 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3792 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3793 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3794
3795 @item
3796 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3797 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3798 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3799 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3800 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3801 @end itemize
3802 @end deffn
3803
3804 @section Custom Reset Handling
3805 @cindex events
3806
3807 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3808 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3809 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3810 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3811 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3812 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3813
3814 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3815 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3816 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3817 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3818 want to reset everything at once.
3819
3820 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3821 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3822 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3823 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3824 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3825 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3826 needs special attention.
3827
3828 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3829 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3830 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3831 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3832 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3833 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3834 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3835 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3836 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3837
3838 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3839 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3840 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3841 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3842 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3843
3844 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3845 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3846 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3847 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3848 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3849 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3850 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3851 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3852 or potentially some other value.
3853
3854 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3855 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3856 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3857 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3858 (or their associated targets)
3859 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3860
3861 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3862 they return.
3863 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3864 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3865 @end deffn
3866
3867 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3868 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3869 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3870 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3871 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3872 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3873 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3874 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3875 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3876 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3877 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3878 @end deffn
3879
3880 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3881 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3882 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3883 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3884 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3885 @end deffn
3886
3887
3888 @node TAP Declaration
3889 @chapter TAP Declaration
3890 @cindex TAP declaration
3891 @cindex TAP configuration
3892
3893 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3894 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3895
3896 @itemize @bullet
3897 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3898 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3899 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3900 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3901 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3902 start running that code.
3903 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3904 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3905 and missing connections.
3906 @end itemize
3907
3908 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3909 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3910 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3911 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3912 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3913
3914 @section Scan Chains
3915 @cindex scan chain
3916
3917 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3918 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3919 They also need to be added to
3920 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3921 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3922 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3923 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3924 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3925 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3926 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3927 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3928
3929 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3930 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3931 command, presented in the next chapter.
3932 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3933 debugging targets.)
3934 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3935
3936 @verbatim
3937 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3938 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3939 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3940 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3941 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3942 @end verbatim
3943
3944 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3945 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3946 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3947 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3948 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3949 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3950 until they are told to do so.
3951
3952 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3953 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3954 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3955 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3956
3957 @example
3958 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3959 @end example
3960
3961 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3962 by a given chip.
3963 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3964 and so forth.
3965 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3966 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3967 both inside a single chip and between them.
3968 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3969
3970 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3971 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3972 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3973 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3974 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3975 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3976 includes commands something like this:
3977
3978 @example
3979 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3980 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3981 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3982 @end example
3983
3984 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3985 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3986 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3987
3988 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3989 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3990 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3991 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3992 @example
3993 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3994 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3995 @}
3996 @end example
3997 @end deffn
3998
3999 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4000 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4001 and their status.
4002 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4003 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4004 but systems with a JTAG router can
4005 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4006 @end deffn
4007
4008 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4009 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4010
4011 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4012 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4013
4014 @section TAP Names
4015 @cindex dotted name
4016
4017 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4018 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4019 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4020 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4021 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4022 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4023 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4024 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4025
4026 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4027 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4028 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4029
4030 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4031
4032 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4033 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4034 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4035
4036 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4037 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4038 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4039 overridable.
4040
4041 @cindex TAP naming convention
4042 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4043 and should follow this convention:
4044
4045 @itemize @bullet
4046 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4047 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4048 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4049 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4050 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4051 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4052 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4053 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4054 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4055 with a single TAP;
4056 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4057 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4058 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4059 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4060 @end itemize
4061
4062 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4063
4064 @itemize @bullet
4065 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4066 @*The length in bits of the
4067 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4068 @end itemize
4069
4070 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4071
4072 @itemize @bullet
4073 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4074 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4075 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4076 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4077 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4078 (the TAP is linked in).
4079 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4080 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4081 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4082 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4083 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4084 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4085 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4086 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4087 values that were found but not included in the list.
4088
4089 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4090 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4091 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4092 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4093 hardware to find these values.
4094 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4095 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4096 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4097 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4098 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4099 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4100 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4101 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4102 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4103 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4104 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4105 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4106 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4107 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4108 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4109 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4110 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4111 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4112 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4113 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4114 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4115 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4116 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4117 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4118 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4119 @end itemize
4120 @end deffn
4121
4122 @section Other TAP commands
4123
4124 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4125 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4126 @end deffn
4127
4128 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4129 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4130 At this writing this TAP attribute
4131 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4132 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4133 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4134 See the next section for information about the available events.
4135
4136 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4137 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4138 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4139 @end deffn
4140
4141 @section TAP Events
4142 @cindex events
4143 @cindex TAP events
4144
4145 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4146 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4147 The other applies to debugger targets,
4148 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4149
4150 The TAP events currently defined are:
4151
4152 @itemize @bullet
4153 @item @b{post-reset}
4154 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4155 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4156 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4157 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4158 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4159
4160 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4161 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4162 of any particular target.
4163 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4164 @item @b{setup}
4165 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4166 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4167 @item @b{tap-disable}
4168 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4169 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4170 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4171 @item @b{tap-enable}
4172 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4173 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4174 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4175 @end itemize
4176
4177 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4178 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4179 contents to be accurate), you might:
4180
4181 @example
4182 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4183 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4184 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4185 @}
4186 @end example
4187
4188
4189 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4190 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4191 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4192 @cindex jrc
4193
4194 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4195 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4196 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4197 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4198 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4199
4200 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4201 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4202 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4203 be visible.
4204 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4205 ignores, such as:
4206
4207 @itemize
4208 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4209 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4210 TAPs receive new instructions.
4211 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4212 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4213 @end itemize
4214
4215 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4216 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4217 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4218 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4219
4220 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4221 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4222
4223 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4224 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4225 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4226 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4227 should define TAP event handlers using
4228 code that looks something like this:
4229
4230 @example
4231 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4232 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4233 @}
4234 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4235 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4236 @}
4237 @end example
4238
4239 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4240
4241 @example
4242 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4243 @end example
4244
4245 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4246 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4247 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4248 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4249
4250 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4251 If necessary, disables the tap
4252 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4253 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4254 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4255 and "0" if it is disabled.
4256 @end deffn
4257
4258 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4259 If necessary, enables the tap
4260 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4261 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4262 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4263 and "0" if it is disabled.
4264 @end deffn
4265
4266 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4267 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4268 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4269 and "0" if it is disabled.
4270
4271 @quotation Note
4272 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4273 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4274 @end quotation
4275 @end deffn
4276
4277 @anchor{autoprobing}
4278 @section Autoprobing
4279 @cindex autoprobe
4280 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4281
4282 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4283 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4284 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4285 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4286
4287 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4288 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4289 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4290 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4291 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4292 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4293 right when they come out of reset).
4294
4295 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4296
4297 @example
4298 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4299 reset_config trst_and_srst
4300 jtag_rclk 8
4301 @end example
4302
4303 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4304 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4305
4306 @enumerate
4307 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4308 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4309 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4310 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4311 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4312 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4313 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4314 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4315 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4316 that is discovered.
4317 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4318 register, it will report it.
4319 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4320 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4321 @end enumerate
4322
4323 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4324 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4325 that's a bit more complex:
4326
4327 @example
4328 clock speed 8 kHz
4329 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4330 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4331 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4332 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4333 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4334 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4335 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4336 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4337 @end example
4338
4339 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4340 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4341 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4342 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4343 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4344 and so forth.
4345
4346 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4347 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4348 @cindex DAP declaration
4349
4350 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4351 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4352 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4353 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4354 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4355
4356 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4357
4358 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4359 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4360 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4361 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4362 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4363
4364 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4365
4366 @itemize @bullet
4367 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4368 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4369 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4370 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4371 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4372
4373 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4374 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4375 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4376 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4377 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4378 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4379
4380 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4381 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4382 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4383 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4384 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4385 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4386 @end itemize
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4390 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4391 for TCL scripting.
4392 @end deffn
4393
4394 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4395 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4396 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4397 @end deffn
4398
4399 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4400 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4401 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4402 initialization, too.
4403 @end deffn
4404
4405 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4406
4407 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4408 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4409 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4410 @end deffn
4411
4412 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4413 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4414 @end deffn
4415
4416 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4417 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4418 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4419 or set a new value @var{value}.
4420 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4421 @end deffn
4422
4423 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4424 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4425 @end deffn
4426
4427 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4428 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4429 value @var{value}.
4430
4431 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4432 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4433 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4434
4435 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4436 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4437 @end deffn
4438
4439 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4440 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4441 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4442 @end deffn
4443
4444 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4445 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4446 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4447 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4448 @end deffn
4449
4450 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4451 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4452
4453 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4454 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4455 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4456 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4457 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4458 for details.
4459
4460 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4461 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4462 the pattern:
4463 @example
4464 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4465 @end example
4466
4467 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4468 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4469 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4470 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4471 @example
4472 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4473 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4474 @end example
4475
4476 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4477 @example
4478 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4479 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4480 @end example
4481
4482 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4483 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4484
4485 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4486 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4487 example with a proper dap name:
4488 @example
4489 xxx.dap apcsw default
4490 @end example
4491 @end deffn
4492
4493 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4494 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4495 Disabled by default
4496 @end deffn
4497
4498
4499 @node CPU Configuration
4500 @chapter CPU Configuration
4501 @cindex GDB target
4502
4503 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4504 You can also access these targets without GDB
4505 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4506 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4507 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4508 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4509
4510 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4511 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4512
4513 @section Target List
4514 @cindex target, current
4515 @cindex target, list
4516
4517 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4518 where each member has a name.
4519 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4520 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4521 (plural!) command.
4522 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4523 look like with more than one:
4524 @verbatim
4525 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4526 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4527 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4528 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4529 @end verbatim
4530
4531 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4532 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4533 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4534 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4535 space seen by that current target.
4536 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4537 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4538 are examples; and there are many more.
4539
4540 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4541
4542 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4543 Returns the name of the current target.
4544 @end deffn
4545
4546 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4547 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4548 @example
4549 foreach t [target names] @{
4550 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4551 @}
4552 @end example
4553 @end deffn
4554
4555 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4556 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4557
4558 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4559 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4560 command names are singular.}
4561
4562 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4563 targets in a user friendly form.
4564
4565 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4566 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4567 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4568 @end deffn
4569
4570 @section Target CPU Types
4571 @cindex target type
4572 @cindex CPU type
4573
4574 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4575 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4576 when calling @command{target create}.
4577 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4578 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4579 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4580 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4581 what core-specific commands may be available
4582 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4583 and more.
4584
4585 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4586 since there's a command to list them.
4587
4588 @anchor{targettypes}
4589 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4590 Lists all supported target types.
4591 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4592
4593 @itemize @bullet
4594 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4595 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4596 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4597 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4598 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4599 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4600 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4601 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4602 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4603 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4604 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4605 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4606 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4607 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4608 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4609 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4610 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4611 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4612 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4613 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4614 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4615 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4616 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4617 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4618 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4619 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4620 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4621 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4622 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4623 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4624 support for new CPUs.
4625 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4626 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4627 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4628 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4629 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4630 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4631 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4632 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4633 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4634 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4635 @itemize @minus
4636 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4637 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4638 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4639 @end itemize
4640 And two debug interfaces cores:
4641 @itemize @minus
4642 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4643 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4644 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4645 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4646 @end itemize
4647 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4648 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4649 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4650 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4651 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4652 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4653 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4654 @end itemize
4655 @end deffn
4656
4657 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4658 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4659 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4660 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4661 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4662 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4663 reflect design generations;
4664 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4665 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4666
4667 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4668 @section Target Configuration
4669
4670 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4671 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4672 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4673 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4674 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4675
4676 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4677 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4678 optional parts.
4679 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4680 command, created as part of target creation.
4681
4682 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4683 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4684 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4685 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4686 to be much more board-specific.
4687 The key steps you use might look something like this
4688
4689 @example
4690 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4691 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4692 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4693 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4694 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4695 @end example
4696
4697 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4698 on-chip SRAM.
4699 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4700 writes to target memory;
4701 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4702 GDB memory checksumming;
4703 and more.
4704
4705 @quotation Warning
4706 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4707 inaccessible when application code
4708 (such as an operating system)
4709 enables or disables the MMU.
4710 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4711 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4712 easy access to other addresses needed.
4713 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4714 @end quotation
4715
4716 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4717 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4718 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4719 controllers.
4720 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4721 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4722 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4723
4724 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4725 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4726 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4727 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4728 purposes including additional configuration.
4729
4730 @itemize @bullet
4731 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4732 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4733 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4734 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4735
4736 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4737 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4738 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4739 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4740 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4741 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4742 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4743
4744 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4745 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4746 @end itemize
4747 @end deffn
4748
4749 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4750 The options accepted by this command may also be
4751 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4752 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4753 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4754
4755 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4756 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4757 and changing its endianness.
4758
4759 @itemize @bullet
4760
4761 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4762 used to access this target.
4763
4764 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4765 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4766 create and manage DAP instances.
4767
4768 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4769 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4770
4771 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4772 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4773 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4774 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4775 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4776 same event name assigns only one handler.
4777
4778 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4779 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4780
4781 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4782 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4783 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4784 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4785 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4786 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4787 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4788
4789 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4790 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4791 or virtual address is being used.
4792
4793 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4794 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4795
4796 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4797 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4798 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4799 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4800 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4801
4802 @anchor{rtostype}
4803 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4804 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4805 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4806 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4807 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4808 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4809
4810 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4811 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4812 access the target for debugging.
4813
4814 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4815 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4816 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4817 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4818
4819 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4820 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4821 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4822 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4823 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4824
4825 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4826 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4827 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4828 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4829 command @command{gdb_port}.
4830 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4831
4832 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4833 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4834 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4835 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4836 @end itemize
4837 @end deffn
4838
4839 @section Other $target_name Commands
4840 @cindex object command
4841
4842 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4843 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4844
4845 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4846 Once a button is created a button
4847 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4848 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4849 configure it like this:
4850
4851 @example
4852 # Create
4853 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4854 # Modify
4855 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4856 # Query
4857 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4858 # Report
4859 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4860 @end example
4861
4862 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4863 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4864
4865 @example
4866 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4867 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4868 @end example
4869
4870 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4871
4872 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4873 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4874 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4875 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4876 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4877 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4878 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4879 They are not otherwise documented here.
4880 @end deffn
4881
4882 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4883 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4884 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4885 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4886 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4887 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4888 the target side uses raw memory.
4889
4890 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4891 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4892 The script orientation comes from working with data
4893 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4894 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4895 and neither store nor return those values.
4896
4897 @itemize
4898 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4899 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4900 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4901 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4902 @end itemize
4903 @end deffn
4904
4905 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4906 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4907 @command{$target_name configure}
4908 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4909 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4910 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4911 There are a few special cases:
4912
4913 @itemize @bullet
4914 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4915 event named @var{event_name}.
4916 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4917 two parameters.
4918 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4919 This is a special case because this is set using
4920 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4921 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4922 @end itemize
4923
4924 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4925 all the targets you might use something like this:
4926
4927 @example
4928 foreach name [target names] @{
4929 set y [$name cget -endian]
4930 set z [$name cget -type]
4931 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4932 $x $name $y $z]
4933 @}
4934 @end example
4935 @end deffn
4936
4937 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4938 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4939 Displays the current target state:
4940 @code{debug-running},
4941 @code{halted},
4942 @code{reset},
4943 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4944 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4945 @end deffn
4946
4947 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4948 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4949 currently associated with this target.
4950 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4951 @end deffn
4952
4953 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4954 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4955 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4956 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4957 @end deffn
4958
4959 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4960 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4961 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4962 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4963 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4964 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4965 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4966 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4967 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4968 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4969 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4970 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4971 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4972 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4973 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4974 @end deffn
4975
4976 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4977 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4978 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4979 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4980 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4981 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4982 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4983 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4984 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4985 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4986 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4987 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4988 @end deffn
4989
4990 @anchor{targetevents}
4991 @section Target Events
4992 @cindex target events
4993 @cindex events
4994 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4995 For example:
4996 @itemize @bullet
4997 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4998 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4999 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5000 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5001 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5002 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5003 to set up system clocks or
5004 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5005 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5006 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5007 @end itemize
5008
5009 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5010 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5011 @command{target create ... -event}.
5012
5013 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5014 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5015 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5016
5017 @example
5018 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5019 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5020 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5021 @}
5022 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5023 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5024 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5025 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5026 @}
5027 @end example
5028
5029 The following target events are defined:
5030
5031 @itemize @bullet
5032 @item @b{debug-halted}
5033 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5034 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5035 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5036 @item @b{early-halted}
5037 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5038 @item @b{examine-start}
5039 @* Before target examine is called.
5040 @item @b{examine-end}
5041 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5042 @item @b{examine-fail}
5043 @* After target examine fails.
5044 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5045 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5046 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5047 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5048 connect GDB to running target.
5049 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5050 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5051 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5052 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5053 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5054 is in RAM or read only memory.
5055 Default is @code{halt}
5056 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5057 @* When GDB disconnects
5058 @item @b{gdb-end}
5059 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5060 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5061 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5062 @code{reset init})
5063 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5064 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5065 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5066 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5067 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5068 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5069 @item @b{gdb-start}
5070 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5071 @item @b{halted}
5072 @* The target has halted
5073 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5074 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5075 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5076 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5077 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5078 @item @b{reset-assert}
5079 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5080 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5081 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5082 it instead of asserting SRST.
5083 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5084 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5085 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5086 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5087 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5088 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5089 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5090 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5091 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5092 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5093 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5094 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5095 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5096 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5097 released on the scan chain.
5098 @item @b{reset-end}
5099 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5100 @item @b{reset-init}
5101 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5102 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5103
5104 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5105 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5106 multiplexing, and so on.
5107 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5108 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5109 @item @b{reset-start}
5110 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5111 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5112
5113 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5114 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5115 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5116 @item @b{resume-start}
5117 @* Before any target is resumed
5118 @item @b{resume-end}
5119 @* After all targets have resumed
5120 @item @b{resumed}
5121 @* Target has resumed
5122 @item @b{step-start}
5123 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5124 @item @b{step-end}
5125 @* After single-step has completed
5126 @item @b{trace-config}
5127 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5128 @end itemize
5129
5130 @quotation Note
5131 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5132 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5133 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5134 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5135 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5136 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5137 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5138 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5139 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5140 check if the core has changed status.
5141 @end quotation
5142
5143 @node Flash Commands
5144 @chapter Flash Commands
5145
5146 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5147 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5148 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5149 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5150 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5151 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5152 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5153 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5154 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5155
5156 Flash Steps:
5157 @enumerate
5158 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5159 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5160 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5161 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5162 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5163 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5164 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5165 @item GDB Flashing
5166 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5167 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5168 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5169 @end enumerate
5170
5171 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5172 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5173 so that it can't boot.
5174 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5175 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5176
5177 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5178 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5179 @cindex flash configuration
5180
5181 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5182 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5183 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5184 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5185 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5186 see the driver-specific documentation.
5187
5188 @itemize @bullet
5189 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5190 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5191 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5192 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5193 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5194 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5195 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5196 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5197 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5198 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5199 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5200 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5201 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5202 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5203 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5204 commands to the flash controller.
5205 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5206 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5207 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5208 for more information.
5209 @end itemize
5210 @quotation Note
5211 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5212 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5213 @end quotation
5214 @end deffn
5215
5216 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5217 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5218 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5219 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5220 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5221 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5222 @end deffn
5223
5224 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5225 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5226 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5227 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5231 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5232 depends on the flash type.
5233 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5234 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5235 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5236 but most don't bother.
5237 @end deffn
5238
5239 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5240
5241 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5242 begins.
5243
5244 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5245 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5246 until the programming session is finished.
5247
5248 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5249 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5250
5251 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5252
5253 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5254 @cindex flash erasing
5255 @cindex flash reading
5256 @cindex flash writing
5257 @cindex flash programming
5258 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5259
5260 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5261 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5262 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5263 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5264 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5265
5266 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5267 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5268 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5269 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5270 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5271
5272 @quotation Note
5273 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5274 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5275 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5276 back to a flash bank.
5277 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5278 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5279 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5280 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5281 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5282 @end quotation
5283
5284 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5285 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5286 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5287 disabled first.
5288 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5289 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5290 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5291
5292 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5293 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5294 up to and including @var{last}.
5295 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5296 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5297 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5298 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5299 @end deffn
5300
5301 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5302 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5303 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5304 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5305 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5306 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5307 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5308 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5309 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5310 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5311 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5312 before erase starts.
5313 @end deffn
5314
5315 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5316 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5317 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5318 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5319 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5320 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5321 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5322 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5323 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5324 before issuing this command.
5325 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5326 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5327 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5328 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5329 @end deffn
5330 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5331
5332 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5333 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5334 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5335 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5336 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5337 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5338 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5339 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5340 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5341 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5342 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5343 @end deffn
5344
5345 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5346 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5347 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5348 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5349 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5350 @end deffn
5351
5352 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5353 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5354 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5355 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5356 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5357 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5358 @end deffn
5359
5360 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5361 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5362 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5363 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5364 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5365 @end deffn
5366
5367 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5368 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5369 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5370 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5371 to the base address for each section in the image.
5372 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5373 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5374 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5375 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5376 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5377 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5378 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5379 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5380 each image section.
5381
5382 @quotation Warning
5383 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5384 data you want to preserve.
5385 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5386 sections might be erased with no notice.
5387 @itemize
5388 @item
5389 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5390 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5391 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5392 @item
5393 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5394 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5395 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5396 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5397 @end itemize
5398 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5399 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5400 @end quotation
5401
5402 @end deffn
5403
5404 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5405 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5406 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5407 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5408 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5409 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5410 ordinary memory reads.
5411 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5412 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5413 check for successful programming.
5414 @end deffn
5415
5416 @section Other Flash commands
5417 @cindex flash protection
5418
5419 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5420 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5421 and display that status.
5422 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5423 @end deffn
5424
5425 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5426 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5427 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5428
5429 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5430 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5431 and possibly stale information.
5432 @end deffn
5433
5434 @anchor{flashprotect}
5435 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5436 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5437 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5438 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5439 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5440 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5441 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5442 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5443 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5444 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5445 @end deffn
5446
5447 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5448 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5449 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5450 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @anchor{program}
5454 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5455 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5456 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5457 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5461 @section Flash Driver List
5462 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5463 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5464 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5465
5466 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5467 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5468 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5469
5470 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5471
5472 @itemize
5473 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5474 @end itemize
5475
5476 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5477 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5478 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5479 @example
5480 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5481 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5482 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5483 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5484 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5485 @end example
5486 @end deffn
5487
5488 @subsection External Flash
5489
5490 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5491 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5492 @cindex CFI
5493 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5494 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5495 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5496 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5497 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5498 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5499 configure a bus and its timings), or
5500 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5501 on the flash chip.
5502 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5503 speed up operation.
5504
5505 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5506
5507 @itemize
5508 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5509 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5510 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5511 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5512 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5513 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5514 @end itemize
5515
5516 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5517 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5518
5519 @example
5520 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5521 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5522 @end example
5523
5524 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5525 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5526 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5527
5528 @example
5529 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5530 @end example
5531
5532 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5533 @end deffn
5534
5535 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5536 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5537 @cindex SPI
5538 @cindex jtagspi
5539 @cindex bscan_spi
5540 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5541 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5542 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5543 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5544 accessed through JTAG.
5545
5546 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5547 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5548 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5549 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5550 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5551 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5552
5553 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5554 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5555 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5556 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5557 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5558 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5559 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5560 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5561
5562 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5563 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5564 command, see below.
5565
5566 @itemize
5567 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5568 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5569 @var{USER1} instruction.
5570 @end itemize
5571
5572 @example
5573 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5574 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5575 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5576 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5577 @end example
5578
5579 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5580 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5581 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5582 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5583 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5584 @example
5585 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5586 @end example
5587 @end deffn
5588
5589 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5590 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5591 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5592 @example
5593 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5594 @end example
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5598 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5599 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5600 @end deffn
5601 @end deffn
5602
5603 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5604 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5605 @cindex xcf
5606 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5607 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5608 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5609 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5610 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5611
5612 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5613 command accepts additional parameters:
5614 @itemize
5615 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5616 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5617 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5618 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5619 in master mode.
5620 @end itemize
5621 @example
5622 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5623 @end example
5624 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5625 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5626 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5627 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5628 dedicated sector.
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5632 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5633 button.
5634 @example
5635 xcf configure 0
5636 @end example
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 Additional driver notes:
5640 @itemize
5641 @item Only single revision supported.
5642 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5643 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5644 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5645 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5646 @end itemize
5647 @end deffn
5648
5649 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5650 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5651 @cindex SPIFI
5652 @cindex lpcspifi
5653 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5654 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5655 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5656
5657 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5658 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5659 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5660 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5661 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5662
5663 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5664 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5665 are configured by the driver.
5666
5667 @example
5668 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5669 @end example
5670
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5674 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5675 @cindex SMI
5676 @cindex stmsmi
5677 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5678 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5679 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5680 SPI flash devices.
5681 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5682 flash devices can be connected.
5683
5684 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5685 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5686 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5687 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5688 the flash content.
5689
5690 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5691 to identify the memory bank.
5692 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5693 flash size, are detected automatically.
5694
5695 @example
5696 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5697 @end example
5698
5699 @end deffn
5700
5701 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5702 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5703 @cindex QuadSPI
5704 @cindex OctoSPI
5705 @cindex stmqspi
5706 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5707 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5708 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5709 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5710 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5711 mode is not.
5712
5713 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5714 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5715 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5716 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5717
5718 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5719 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5720 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5721
5722 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5723 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5724 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5725 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5726 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5727 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5728
5729 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5730 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5731 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5732 should be avoided.
5733
5734 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5735 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5736 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5737 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5738 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5739 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5740
5741 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5742 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5743 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5744 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5745 persist across openocd invocations.
5746
5747 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5748 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5749 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5750 required (see 'set' command).
5751
5752 @example
5753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5754 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5756 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5757 @end example
5758
5759 There are three specific commands
5760 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5761 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5762 chip specific write protection engaged.
5763 @end deffn
5764
5765 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5766 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5767 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5768 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5769 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5770 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5771
5772 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5773 which don't support an id command.
5774
5775 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5776 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5777 @end deffn
5778
5779 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5780 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5781 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5782 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5783 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5784
5785 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5786 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5787 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5788 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5789
5790 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5791
5792 To check basic communication settings, issue
5793 @example
5794 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5795 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5796 @end example
5797 for single flash mode or
5798 @example
5799 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5800 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5801 @end example
5802 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5803
5804 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5805 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5806 need a dummy address, e.g.
5807 @example
5808 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5809 @end example
5810 should return the status register contents.
5811
5812 @end deffn
5813
5814 @end deffn
5815
5816 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5817 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5818 Microcontroller platform.
5819
5820 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5821 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5822
5823 @example
5824 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5825 @end example
5826
5827 @end deffn
5828
5829 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5830 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5831 @cindex ath79
5832 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5833 chip selects.
5834 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5835 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5836 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5837 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5838 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5839 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5840
5841 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5842 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5843 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5844 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5845 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5846 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5847 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5848 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5849 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5850 with the default CS0.
5851 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5852 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5853 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5854
5855 @example
5856 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5857
5858 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5859 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5860 # distinguish the banks.
5861 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5862 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5863 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5864 @end example
5865
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5869 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5870 @cindex fespi
5871
5872 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5873
5874 @example
5875 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5876 @end example
5877 @end deffn
5878
5879 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5880
5881 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5882 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5883 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5884 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5885 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5886 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5887
5888 @example
5889 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5890 @end example
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5894 @cindex ambiqmicro
5895 @cindex apollo
5896 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5897 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5898 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5899 with the target using SWD.
5900
5901 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5902 the device class of the MCU.
5903 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5904 to set up the flash banks.
5905 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5906 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5907
5908 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5909 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5910 and the second bank starts after the first.
5911
5912 @example
5913 # Flash bank 0
5914 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5915 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5916 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5917 $_TARGETNAME
5918 @end example
5919
5920 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5921 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5922 are available to the user.
5923
5924 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5925
5926 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5927 Erase entire bank.
5928 @end deffn
5929 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5930 Erase device pages.
5931 @end deffn
5932 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5933 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5934 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5935 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5936 the flash.
5937 @end deffn
5938 @end deffn
5939
5940 @anchor{at91samd}
5941 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5942 @cindex at91samd
5943 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5944 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5945
5946 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5947
5948 The devices have one flash bank:
5949
5950 @example
5951 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5952 @end example
5953
5954 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5955 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5956 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5957 processor to be halted.
5958 @end deffn
5959
5960 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5961 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5962 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5963 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5964 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5965 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5966
5967 @example
5968 at91samd set-security enable
5969 @end example
5970 @end deffn
5971
5972 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5973 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5974 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5975 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5976 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5977 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5978 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5979 in order to disable this feature.
5980
5981 @example
5982 at91samd eeprom
5983 at91samd eeprom 1024
5984 @end example
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5988 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5989 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5990 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5991 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5992 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5993
5994 @example
5995 at91samd bootloader
5996 at91samd bootloader 16384
5997 @end example
5998 @end deffn
5999
6000 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6001 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6002 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6003 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6007 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6008 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6009 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6010 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6011 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6012 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6013 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6014
6015 @example
6016 # Read user row
6017 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6018 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6019 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6020 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6021 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6022 # byte unchanged
6023 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6024 @end example
6025 @end deffn
6026
6027 @end deffn
6028
6029 @anchor{at91sam3}
6030 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6031 @cindex at91sam3
6032 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6033 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6034 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6035 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6036 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6037 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6038 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6039 chips are confirmed.}
6040
6041 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6042 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6043 the following fixed locations:
6044
6045 @example
6046 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6047 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6048 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6049 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6050 @end example
6051
6052 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6053 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6054 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6055
6056 @itemize
6057 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6058 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6059 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6060 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6061 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6062 @end itemize
6063
6064 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6065
6066 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6067 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6068 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6069 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6070 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6071 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6072 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6073
6074 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6075 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6076 @end deffn
6077
6078 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6079 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6080 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6081 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6082 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6083 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6084 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6085 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6086 @end deffn
6087
6088 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6089 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6090 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6091 @end deffn
6092 @end deffn
6093
6094 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6095 @cindex at91sam4
6096 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6097 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6098 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6099 @end deffn
6100
6101 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6102 @cindex at91sam4l
6103 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6104 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6105 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6106
6107 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6108 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6109 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6110 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6111 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6112 @end deffn
6113 @end deffn
6114
6115 @anchor{atsame5}
6116 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6117 @cindex atsame5
6118 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6119 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6120 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6121
6122 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6123 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6124 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6125
6126 @example
6127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6128 @end example
6129
6130 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6131 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6132 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6133 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6134 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6135 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6136
6137 @example
6138 atsame5 bootloader
6139 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6140 @end example
6141 @end deffn
6142
6143 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6144 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6145 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6146 processor to be halted.
6147 @end deffn
6148
6149 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6150 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6151 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6152 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6153 @end deffn
6154
6155 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6156 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6157 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6158 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6159 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6160 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6161 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6162 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6163
6164 @example
6165 # Read
6166 >atsame5 userpage
6167 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6168 # Write
6169 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6170 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6171 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6172 # bytes)
6173 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6174 @end example
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @end deffn
6178
6179 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6180 @cindex atsamv
6181 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6182 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6183 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6187 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6188 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6189 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6190 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6191
6192 @example
6193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6194 @end example
6195
6196 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6197 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6198
6199 @itemize
6200 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6201 @item @var{banks}
6202 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6203 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6204 @item @var{pages_size}
6205 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6206 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6207 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6208 @end itemize
6209
6210 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6211 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6212 will be autoconfigured.
6213 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6214
6215 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6216 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6217 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6218 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6219 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6220
6221 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6222 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6223 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6224 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6225 are not truly general purpose).
6226 @quotation Note
6227 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6228 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6229 @end quotation
6230 @end deffn
6231 @end deffn
6232
6233 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6234 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6235 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6236 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6237 @end deffn
6238
6239 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6240 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6241 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6242 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6243
6244 @example
6245 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6246 @end example
6247
6248 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6249 each single sector one by one.
6250
6251 @example
6252 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6253 @end example
6254
6255 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6256 @end deffn
6257
6258 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6259 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6260 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6261 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6262 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6263 starts at address 0.
6264
6265 @example
6266 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6267 @end example
6268 @end deffn
6269
6270 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6271 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6272 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6273 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6274 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6275 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6276 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6277 and programming the serial flash.
6278
6279 @example
6280 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6281 @end example
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6285 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6286 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6287 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6288 autoconfigures itself.
6289 @example
6290 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6291 @end example
6292 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6293 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6294 this via the following command:
6295 @example
6296 efm32 debuglock num
6297 @end example
6298 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6299 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6300 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6301 supported.}
6302 @end deffn
6303
6304 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6305 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6306 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6307 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6308 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6309 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6310
6311 @example
6312 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6313 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6314 @end example
6315
6316 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6317 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6318 @end deffn
6319
6320 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6321 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6322 is an uncommon operation.}
6323 @end deffn
6324 @end deffn
6325
6326 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6327 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6328 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6329 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6330 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6331 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6332 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6333
6334 @example
6335 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6336 @end example
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6340 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6341 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6342 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6343 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6344 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6345 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6346 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6347 characters) ignored.
6348
6349 @example
6350 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6351 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6352 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6353 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6354 @end example
6355 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6356 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6357 @end deffn
6358
6359 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6360 @cindex kinetis
6361 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6362 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6363 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6364 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6365 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6366 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6367
6368 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6369 @itemize
6370 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6371 @end itemize
6372
6373 @example
6374 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6375 @end example
6376
6377 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6378 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6379 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6380 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6381 @end deffn
6382
6383 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6384 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6385 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6386 set by 'flash protect' command.
6387 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6388 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6389 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6390 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6391 with the rest of a flash image.
6392 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6393 @end deffn
6394
6395 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6396 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6397 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6398 @end deffn
6399
6400 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6401 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6402 and examine-fail event.
6403 @end deffn
6404
6405 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6406 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6407 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6408 @end deffn
6409
6410 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6411 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6412 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6413 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6414 command completes.
6415 @end deffn
6416
6417 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6418 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6419 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6420 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6421 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6422
6423 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6424 Program Partition command.
6425
6426 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6427 Reset the device after partition setting.
6428
6429 Show partition size:
6430 @example
6431 kinetis nvm_partition info
6432 @end example
6433
6434 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6435 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6436 @example
6437 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6438 @end example
6439
6440 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6441 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6442 @example
6443 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6444 @end example
6445 @end deffn
6446
6447 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6448 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6449 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6450 @end deffn
6451
6452 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6453 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6454 Command disables watchdog timer.
6455 @end deffn
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6459 @cindex kinetis_ke
6460 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6461 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6462 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6463 autoconfigures itself.
6464 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6465
6466 @example
6467 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6468 @end example
6469
6470 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6471 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6472 @end deffn
6473
6474 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6475 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6476 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6477 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6478 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6479 @end deffn
6480
6481 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6482 Command disables watchdog timer.
6483 @end deffn
6484 @end deffn
6485
6486 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6487 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6488 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6489 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6490 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6491
6492 @quotation Note
6493 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6494 driver:
6495 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6496 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6497 @end quotation
6498
6499 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6500 which must appear in the following order:
6501
6502 @itemize
6503 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6504 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6505 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6506 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6507 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6508 LPC43x[2357])
6509 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6510 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6511 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6512 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6513 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6514 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6515 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6516 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6517 at which the core is running
6518 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6519 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6520 @quotation Note
6521 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6522 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6523 However, if you do provide it,
6524 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6525 @end quotation
6526 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6527 ROM IAP entry point.
6528 @end itemize
6529
6530 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6531
6532 @example
6533 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6534 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6535 @end example
6536
6537 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6538 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6539 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6540 @end deffn
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6544 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6545 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6546 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6547 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6548 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6549
6550 @example
6551 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6552 @end example
6553 @end deffn
6554
6555 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6556 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6557 from NXP.
6558
6559 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6560 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6561 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6562 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6563 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6564 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6565 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6566 you start the PLL.
6567
6568 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6569
6570 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6571 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6572 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6573
6574 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6575 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6576 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6577 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6578 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6579 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6580 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6581
6582 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6583 @example
6584 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6585 @end example
6586
6587 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6588 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6589 @code{flash banks} command.
6590
6591 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6592 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6593 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6594 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6595 a known signature.
6596 Example:
6597 @example
6598 lpc2900 signature 0
6599 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6600 @end example
6601 @end deffn
6602
6603 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6604 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6605 saves it to a file in binary format.
6606 Example:
6607 @example
6608 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6609 @end example
6610 @end deffn
6611
6612 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6613 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6614 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6615 command:
6616
6617 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6618 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6619 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6620 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6621
6622 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6623 Example:
6624 @example
6625 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6626 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6627 @end example
6628 @end deffn
6629
6630 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6631 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6632 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6633 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6634 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6635 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6636 912 bytes.
6637 @quotation Attention
6638 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6639 @end quotation
6640 Example:
6641 @example
6642 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6643 @end example
6644 @end deffn
6645
6646 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6647 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6648 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6649 after the next power cycle.
6650 @quotation Attention
6651 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6652 @end quotation
6653 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6654 Example:
6655 @example
6656 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6657 flash info 0
6658 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6659 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6660 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6661 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6662 @end example
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6666 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6667 effective after the next power cycle.
6668 @quotation Attention
6669 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6670 @end quotation
6671 Examples:
6672 @example
6673 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6674 @end example
6675 @end deffn
6676 @end deffn
6677
6678 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6679 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6680 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6681 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6682
6683 @example
6684 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6685 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6686 @end example
6687
6688 @itemize @bullet
6689 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6690 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6691 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6692 @end itemize
6693
6694 Example usage:
6695 @example
6696 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6697 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6698 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6699 @} else @{
6700 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6701 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6702 @}
6703 @end example
6704 @end deffn
6705
6706 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6707 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6708 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6709 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6710 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6711 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6712
6713 @example
6714 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6715 @end example
6716
6717 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6718 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6719 only the main program flash.
6720
6721 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6722 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6723 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6724 @end deffn
6725
6726 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6727 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6728 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6729 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6730
6731 To erase and program the BSL:
6732 @example
6733 msp432 bsl unlock
6734 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6735 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6736 msp432 bsl lock
6737 @end example
6738 @end deffn
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6742 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6743 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6744 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6745 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6746 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6747 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6748 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6749 also have division into regions: main and info.
6750 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6751 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6752
6753 @example
6754 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6755 @end example
6756
6757 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6758
6759 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6760 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6761 @end deffn
6762
6763 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6764 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6765 @end deffn
6766
6767 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6768 Erase all userflash including info region.
6769 @end deffn
6770
6771 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6772 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6773 @end deffn
6774
6775 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6776 Check sectors protect.
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6780 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6784 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6785 @end deffn
6786
6787 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6788 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6792 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6796 Show information about flash driver.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @end deffn
6800
6801 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6802 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6803 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6804 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6805 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6806
6807 @example
6808 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6809 @end example
6810 @end deffn
6811
6812 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6813 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6814 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6815 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6816 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6817
6818 @example
6819 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6820 @end example
6821
6822 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6823
6824 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6825 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6826 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6827 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6828 code.
6829 @end deffn
6830
6831 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6832 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6838 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6839 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6840
6841 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6842 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6843 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6844 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6845
6846 @example
6847 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6848 @end example
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6852 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6853 and integrate flash memory.
6854
6855 @example
6856 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6857 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6858 @end example
6859
6860 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6861 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6862 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6863 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6864 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6865 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6866 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6867 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6868 @end deffn
6869 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6870 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6871 This will remove any Code Protection.
6872 @end deffn
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6876 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6877 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6878 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6879 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6880
6881 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6882 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6883
6884 @example
6885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6886 @end example
6887
6888 psoc4-specific commands
6889 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6890 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6891
6892 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6893 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6894
6895 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6896 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6897 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6898
6899 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6900 @end deffn
6901
6902 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6903 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6904
6905 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6906 @end deffn
6907 @end deffn
6908
6909 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6910 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6911 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6912 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6913 apart from the base address.
6914
6915 @example
6916 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6917 @end example
6918
6919 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6920 @quotation Attention
6921 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6922 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6923 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6924 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6925 @end quotation
6926
6927 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6928
6929 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6930 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6931 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6932 @end deffn
6933 @end deffn
6934
6935 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6936 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6937 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6938 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6939 apart from the base address.
6940
6941 @example
6942 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6943 $_TARGETNAME
6944 @end example
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6948 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6949 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6950 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6951
6952 @example
6953 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6954 @end example
6955
6956 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6957
6958 @itemize
6959 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6960 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6961 @end itemize
6962
6963 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6964
6965 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6966 @quotation Attention
6967 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6968 after successful write.
6969 @end quotation
6970 @end deffn
6971
6972 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6973 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6974 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6975 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6976
6977 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6978 @itemize @bullet
6979 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6980 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6981 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6982 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6983 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6984 row size: 512 bytes.
6985 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6986 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6987 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6988 operation will erase row automatically.
6989 @end itemize
6990
6991 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6992 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6993
6994 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6995
6996 @example
6997 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6998 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6999 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7000 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7001 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7002 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7003 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7004 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7005 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7006 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7007 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7008 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7009
7010 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7011 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7012 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7013 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7014 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7015 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7016 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7017 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7018 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7019 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7020 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7021 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7022 @end example
7023
7024 psoc6-specific commands
7025 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7026 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7027 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7028 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7029 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7030 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7034 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7035 by @command{flash banks}.
7036 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7037 @end deffn
7038 @end deffn
7039
7040 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7041 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7042 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7043 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7044 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7045
7046 @example
7047 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7048 @end example
7049 @end deffn
7050
7051 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7052 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7053 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7054 and SWD interface.
7055 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7056 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7057
7058 @example
7059 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7060 @end example
7061
7062 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7063
7064 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7065 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7066 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7070 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7071 @end deffn
7072 @end deffn
7073
7074 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7075 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7076 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7077 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7078 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7079
7080 @example
7081 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7082 @end example
7083
7084 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7085 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7086 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7087 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7088 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7089 disabled.
7090
7091 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7092 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7093 @quotation Warning
7094 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7095 applied to all of them.
7096 @end quotation
7097 @end deffn
7098 @end deffn
7099
7100 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7101 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7102 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7103 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7104 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7105 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7106
7107 @example
7108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7109 @end example
7110
7111 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7112 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7113 the flash driver.
7114
7115 @example
7116 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7117 @end example
7118
7119 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7120 as per the following example.
7121 @example
7122 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7123 @end example
7124
7125 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7126
7127 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7128 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7129 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7133 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7134 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7135 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7136 @end deffn
7137
7138 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7139 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7140 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7141 @end deffn
7142
7143 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7144 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7145 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7146 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7147 @end deffn
7148
7149 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7150 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7151 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7152 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7156 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7157 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7158 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7159 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7160 @end deffn
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7164 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7165 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7166 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7167 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7168
7169 @example
7170 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7171 @end example
7172
7173 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7174 as per the following example.
7175 @example
7176 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7177 @end example
7178
7179 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7180 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7181 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7185 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7186 the flash driver.
7187
7188 @example
7189 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7190 @end example
7191
7192 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7193
7194 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7195 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7196 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7197 @end deffn
7198
7199 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7200 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7201 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7205 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7206 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7207 @end deffn
7208
7209 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7210 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7211 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7215 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7216 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7217 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7218 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7219 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7223 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7224 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7225 @end deffn
7226 @end deffn
7227
7228 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7229 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7230 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7231 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7232 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7233
7234 @example
7235 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7236 @end example
7237
7238 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7239 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7240 the flash driver.
7241
7242 @example
7243 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7244 @end example
7245
7246 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7247
7248 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7249 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7250 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7254 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7255 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7256 @end deffn
7257
7258 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7259 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7260 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7261 @end deffn
7262
7263 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7264 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7265 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7266 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7267 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7268
7269 Example usage:
7270 @example
7271 # read OPTSR_CUR
7272 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7273 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7274 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7275 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7276 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7277 @end example
7278 @end deffn
7279
7280 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7281 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7282 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7283 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7284 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7285 will be touched).
7286
7287 Example usage:
7288 @example
7289 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7290 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7291 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7292 @end example
7293 @end deffn
7294 @end deffn
7295
7296 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7297 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7298 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7299 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7300 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7301
7302 @example
7303 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7304 @end example
7305
7306 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7307 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7308 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7309 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7310 second bank.
7311
7312 @example
7313 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7314 @end example
7315
7316 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7317
7318 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7319 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7320 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7321 @end deffn
7322
7323 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7324 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7325 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7326 @end deffn
7327
7328 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7329 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7330 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7331 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7332 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7333 @end deffn
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7337 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7338 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7339 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7340 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7341 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7342
7343 @example
7344 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7345 @end example
7346
7347 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7348 as per the following example.
7349 @example
7350 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7351 @end example
7352
7353 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7354 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7355 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7359 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7360 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7361 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7362
7363 @example
7364 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7365 @end example
7366
7367 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7368
7369 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7370 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7371 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7372
7373 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7374 @end deffn
7375
7376 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7377 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7378 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7379
7380 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7381 @end deffn
7382
7383 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7384 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7385 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7389 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7390 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7391 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7392
7393 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7394 @example
7395 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7396 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7397 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7398 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7399 @end example
7400
7401 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7402 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7406 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7407 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7408 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7409 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7410
7411 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7412
7413 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7414 @example
7415 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7416 @end example
7417
7418 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7419 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7420 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7424 List the protected areas using WRP.
7425 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7426 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7427 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7428
7429 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7430 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7431 in single or dual-banks mode.
7432 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7433 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7434
7435 @end deffn
7436
7437 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7438 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7439 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7440 @end deffn
7441
7442 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7443 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7444 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7445 the TrustZone status.
7446 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7447 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7448 @end deffn
7449 @end deffn
7450
7451 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7452 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7453 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7454 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7455 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7456
7457 @example
7458 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7459 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7460 @end example
7461
7462 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7463 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7464 for the specified flash bank.
7465 @end deffn
7466 @end deffn
7467
7468 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7469 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7470 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7471 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7472 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7473
7474 @example
7475 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7476 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7477 @end example
7478
7479 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7480 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7481 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7482
7483 @itemize @bullet
7484 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7485 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7486 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7487 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7488 @end itemize
7489 @end deffn
7490
7491 @end deffn
7492
7493 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7494 @cindex str9xpec
7495
7496 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7497 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7498 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7499 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7500
7501 Here is some background info to help
7502 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7503 the str9:
7504 @enumerate
7505 @item
7506 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7507 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7508 @item
7509 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7510 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7511 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7512 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7513 @end enumerate
7514
7515 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7516 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7517 configured for flash bank 0.
7518 @example
7519 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7520 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7521 adapter assert srst
7522 # turn off target polling
7523 poll off
7524 # disable str9 core
7525 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7526 # read option bytes
7527 str9xpec options_read 0
7528 # re-enable str9 core
7529 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7530 poll on
7531 reset halt
7532 @end example
7533 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7534 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7535 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7536 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7537
7538 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7539
7540 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7541 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7542 @end deffn
7543
7544 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7545 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7546 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7547 @end deffn
7548
7549 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7550 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7551 erase the device.
7552 @end deffn
7553
7554 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7555 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7556 @end deffn
7557
7558 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7559 Configure str9 boot bank.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7563 Configure str9 lvd source.
7564 @end deffn
7565
7566 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7567 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7571 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7572 @end deffn
7573
7574 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7575 Read str9 option bytes.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7579 Write str9 option bytes.
7580 @end deffn
7581
7582 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7583 unlock str9 device.
7584 @end deffn
7585
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7589 @cindex swm050
7590 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7591
7592 @example
7593 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7594 @end example
7595
7596 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7597
7598 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7599 Erases the entire flash bank.
7600 @end deffn
7601
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604
7605 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7606 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7607 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7608 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7609
7610 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7611
7612 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7613 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7617 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7621 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7622 the flash clock.
7623 @end deffn
7624 @end deffn
7625
7626 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7627 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7628 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7629 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7630 correct bank config.
7631
7632 @example
7633 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7634 @end example
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7638 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7639 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7640 @end deffn
7641
7642 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7643 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7644 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7645
7646 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7647
7648 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7649 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7650 @end deffn
7651
7652 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7653 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @end deffn
7657
7658 @section NAND Flash Commands
7659 @cindex NAND
7660
7661 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7662 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7663 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7664
7665 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7666 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7667 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7668 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7669 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7670 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7671
7672 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7673 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7674 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7675 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7676 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7677 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7678 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7679 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7680 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7681 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7682
7683 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7684 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7685 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7686 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7687 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7688 every 512 bytes of data.
7689
7690 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7691 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7692 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7693 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7694 ECC mode is used.
7695
7696 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7697 @enumerate
7698 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7699 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7700 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7701 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7702 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7703 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7704 to access that device.
7705 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7706 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7707 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7708 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7709 de-brick a board.
7710 @end enumerate
7711
7712 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7713 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7714 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7715 are only 32 bits wide.
7716 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7717 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7718 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7719 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7720
7721 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7722 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7723 @cindex NAND configuration
7724
7725 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7726 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7727 OpenOCD has initialized.
7728
7729 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7730 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7731 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7732 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7733 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7734 they were a single (larger) device.
7735 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7736 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7737
7738 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7739 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7740 configuration files, not interactively.
7741
7742 @itemize @bullet
7743 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7744 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7745 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7746 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7747 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7748 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7749 commands to the NAND controller.
7750 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7751 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7752 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7753 for more information.
7754 @end itemize
7755 @end deffn
7756
7757 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7758 Prints a summary of each device declared
7759 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7760 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7761 @example
7762 > nand list
7763 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7764 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7765 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7766 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7767 >
7768 @end example
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7772 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7773 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7774 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7775 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7776 it with most other NAND commands.
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7780
7781 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7782 @cindex NAND reading
7783 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7784 starting at the specified offset.
7785 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7786
7787 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7788 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7789
7790 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7791 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7792 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7793
7794 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7795 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7796 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7797 method which handled that error correction.
7798
7799 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7800 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7801 @itemize @bullet
7802 @item no oob_* parameter
7803 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7804 @item @code{oob_raw}
7805 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7806 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7807 spare areas associated with each data page.
7808 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7809 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7810 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7811 @item @code{oob_only}
7812 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7813 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7814 spare areas associated with each data page.
7815 @end itemize
7816 @end deffn
7817
7818 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7819 @cindex NAND erasing
7820 @cindex NAND programming
7821 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7822 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7823 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7824 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7825 If those parameters are not specified,
7826 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7827 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7828
7829 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7830 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7831 block marker.
7832 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7833 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7834 @end deffn
7835
7836 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7837 @cindex NAND writing
7838 @cindex NAND programming
7839 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7840 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7841 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7842 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7843
7844 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7845 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7846
7847 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7848 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7849 past the end of the device.
7850 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7851 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7852 if that's being written.)
7853
7854 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7855 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7856 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7857
7858 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7859 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7860 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7861 @itemize @bullet
7862 @item no oob_* parameter
7863 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7864 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7865 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7866 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7867 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7868 @item @code{oob_only}
7869 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7870 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7871 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7872 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7873 @item @code{oob_raw}
7874 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7875 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7876 un-altered OOB.
7877 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7878 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7879 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7880 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7881 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7882 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7883 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7884 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7885 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7886 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7887 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7888 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7889 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7890 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7891 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7892 @end itemize
7893 @end deffn
7894
7895 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7896 @cindex NAND verification
7897 @cindex NAND programming
7898 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7899 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7900 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7901
7902 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7903 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7904
7905 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7906 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7907 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7908 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7909 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7910
7911 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7912 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7913 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7914
7915 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7916 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7917 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7918 be removed in a future release.
7919 @end deffn
7920
7921 @subsection Other NAND commands
7922 @cindex NAND other commands
7923
7924 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7925 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7926 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7927 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7928 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7929 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7930 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7931 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7932
7933 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7934 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7935 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7936 @end deffn
7937
7938 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7939 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7940 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7941 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7942 status for each block.
7943 @end deffn
7944
7945 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7946 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7947 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7948
7949 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7950 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7951 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7952 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7953 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7954
7955 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7956 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7957 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7958 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7959 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7960 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7961 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7965 @subsection NAND Driver List
7966 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7967 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7968 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7969
7970 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7971 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7972 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7973 address of the ECC controller.
7974 @example
7975 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7976 @end example
7977 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7978 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7979 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7980 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7981 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7982 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7983 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7984 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7985 @end deffn
7986 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7987 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7988 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7989 @end deffn
7990
7991 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7992 properly configured for input or output.
7993 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7994 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7995 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7996 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7997 @end deffn
7998 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7999 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8000 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8001 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8002 @end deffn
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8006 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8007 chips from Texas Instruments.
8008 It takes three extra parameters:
8009 address of the NAND chip;
8010 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8011 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8012 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8013 @example
8014 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8015 @end example
8016 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8017 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8018 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8019 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8020 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8021 @end deffn
8022
8023 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8024 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8025 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8026 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8027 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8028 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8029 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8030 @end deffn
8031
8032 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8033 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8034 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8035 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8036 @end deffn
8037 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8038
8039 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8040 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8041 should work for this chip as well.
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8045 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8046 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8047 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8048 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8049 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8050 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8051 @example
8052 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8053 @end example
8054 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8055 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8056 without parameter query status.
8057 @end deffn
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8061 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8062 parameter: the address of the controller.
8063 @example
8064 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8065 @end example
8066 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8067 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8068 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8069 change any behavior.
8070 @end deffn
8071
8072 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8073 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8074 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8075 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8076 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8077 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8078 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8079 specialized commands.
8080 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8081 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8082 change any behavior.
8083 @end deffn
8084
8085 @node Flash Programming
8086 @chapter Flash Programming
8087
8088 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8089 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8090 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8091
8092 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8093 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8094
8095 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8096 @enumerate
8097 @item 'init' is executed.
8098 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8099 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8100 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8101 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8102 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8103 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8104 @end enumerate
8105
8106 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8107
8108 @example
8109 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8110 # are optional parameters
8111 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8112 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8113
8114 # binary files need the flash address passing
8115 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8116 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8117 @end example
8118
8119 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8120 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8121 @cindex PLD
8122 @cindex FPGA
8123
8124 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8125 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8126 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8127 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8128 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8129 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8130 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8131
8132 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8133
8134 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8135 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8136 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8137
8138 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8139 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8140
8141 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8142 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8143 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8144 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8145 behavior.
8146 @end deffn
8147
8148 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8149 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8150 @end deffn
8151
8152 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8153 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8154 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8155 @end deffn
8156
8157 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8158
8159 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8160 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8161 that particular type of PLD.
8162
8163 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8164 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8165 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8166
8167 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8168 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8169 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8170
8171 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8172 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8173 for FPGA @var{num}.
8174 @end deffn
8175 @end deffn
8176
8177 @node General Commands
8178 @chapter General Commands
8179 @cindex commands
8180
8181 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8182 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8183 commands are documented elsewhere.
8184
8185 Intent:
8186 @itemize @bullet
8187 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8188 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8189 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8190 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8191
8192 @item @b{From the human}
8193 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8194 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8195
8196 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8197 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8198 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8199
8200 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8201 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8202 port is 5555.
8203 @end itemize
8204
8205
8206 @section Server Commands
8207
8208 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8209 Exits the current telnet session.
8210 @end deffn
8211
8212 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8213 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8214 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8215 Not every command provides helptext.
8216
8217 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8218 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8219 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8220 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8221 @end deffn
8222
8223 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8224 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8225 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8226 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8227 Useful in connection with script files
8228 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8229 @end deffn
8230
8231 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8232 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8233 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8234 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8235
8236 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8237 @example
8238 # redefine shutdown
8239 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8240 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8241 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8242 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8243 original_shutdown
8244 @}
8245 @end example
8246 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8247 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8248 @end deffn
8249
8250 @anchor{debuglevel}
8251 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8252 @cindex message level
8253 Display debug level.
8254 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8255 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8256 Level 0 is error messages only;
8257 level 1 adds warnings;
8258 level 2 adds informational messages;
8259 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8260 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8261 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8262 the command line along with the location of that log
8263 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8264 @xref{Running}.
8265 @end deffn
8266
8267 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8268 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8269 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8270 @example
8271 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8272 @end example
8273 @end deffn
8274
8275 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8276 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8277 the default log output channel is stderr.
8278 @end deffn
8279
8280 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8281 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8282 @end deffn
8283
8284 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8285 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8286 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8287 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8288 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8289 @end deffn
8290
8291 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8292 @section Target State handling
8293 @cindex reset
8294 @cindex halt
8295 @cindex target initialization
8296
8297 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8298 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8299 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8300 a current target which is used to perform the
8301 various operations. The current target may be changed
8302 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8303 target which should become current.
8304
8305 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8306 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8307 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8308 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8309 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8310
8311 @emph{With no arguments}:
8312 list all available registers for the current target,
8313 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8314 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8315 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8316 are flagged as such.
8317
8318 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8319 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8320 bypassing any internal cache.
8321
8322 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8323 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8324 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8325 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8326 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8327 relevant module will flush such values.
8328
8329 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8330 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8331
8332 @example
8333 > reg
8334 ===== ARM registers
8335 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8336 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8337 (2) r2 (/32)
8338 ...
8339 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8340 >
8341 @end example
8342 @end deffn
8343
8344 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8345 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8346 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8347 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8348 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8349 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8350 (and enter debug mode).
8351 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8352
8353 @quotation Warning
8354 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8355 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8356 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8357 power mode by gating the core clock;
8358 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8359
8360 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8361 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8362 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8363 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8364 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8365 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8366
8367 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8368 work with a JTAG debugger.
8369 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8370 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8371 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8372 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8373 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8374 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8375 @end quotation
8376
8377 @end deffn
8378
8379 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8380 Resume the target at its current code position,
8381 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8382 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8383 @end deffn
8384
8385 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8386 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8387 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8388 @end deffn
8389
8390 @anchor{resetcommand}
8391 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8392 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8393 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8394 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8395 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8396 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8397 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8398
8399 The optional parameter specifies what should
8400 happen after the reset.
8401 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8402 The other options will not work on all systems.
8403 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8404
8405 @itemize @minus
8406 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8407 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8408 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8409 @end itemize
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8413 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8414 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8415 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8416 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8417 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8418 state.
8419 @end deffn
8420
8421 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8422 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8423 Set values of reset signals.
8424 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8425 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8426 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8427 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8428
8429 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8430 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8431 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8432 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8433 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8434 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8435 the signal will not be modified.
8436
8437 @quotation Note
8438 TRST is specially handled.
8439 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8440 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8441 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8442 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8443 instead of the TRST signal.
8444 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8445 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8446 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8447 with handlers for that event.
8448 @end quotation
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8452 @section Memory access commands
8453 @cindex memory access
8454
8455 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8456 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8457 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8458 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8459
8460 @enumerate
8461 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8462 to change the current target.
8463 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8464 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8465 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8466 @end enumerate
8467
8468 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8469 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8470 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8471 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8472 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8473 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8474 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8475 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8476 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8477 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8478 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8479 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8480 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8481 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8482 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8483 @end deffn
8484
8485 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8486 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8487 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8488 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8489 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8490 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8491 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8492 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8493 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8494 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8495 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8496 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8497 @end deffn
8498
8499 @anchor{imageaccess}
8500 @section Image loading commands
8501 @cindex image loading
8502 @cindex image dumping
8503
8504 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8505 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8506 binary file named @var{filename}.
8507 @end deffn
8508
8509 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8510 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8511 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8512 @end deffn
8513
8514 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8515 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8516 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8517 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8518 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8519 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8520 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8521 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8522 separately.
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8526 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8527 The file format may optionally be specified
8528 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8529 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8530 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8531 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8532 @example
8533 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8534 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8535 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8536 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8537 $address $length
8538 @}
8539 @end example
8540 @end deffn
8541
8542 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8543 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8544 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8545 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8546 The file format may optionally be specified
8547 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8548 @end deffn
8549
8550 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8551 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8552 The file format may optionally be specified
8553 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8554 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8555 @end deffn
8556
8557 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8558 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8559 The file format may optionally be specified
8560 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8561 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8562 @end deffn
8563
8564
8565 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8566 @cindex breakpoint
8567 @cindex watchpoint
8568
8569 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8570 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8571 watchpoints.
8572 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8573
8574 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8575 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8576 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8577 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8578 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8579 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8580
8581 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8582 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8586 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8587 @end deffn
8588
8589 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8590 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8591 @end deffn
8592
8593 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8594 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8595 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8596 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8597 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8598 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8599 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8600 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8601 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8602 @end deffn
8603
8604
8605 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8606
8607 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8608 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8609 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8610 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8611 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8612 running, can be used.
8613 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8614 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8615 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8616
8617 @quotation Note
8618 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8619 @end quotation
8620
8621 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8622 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8623 communication, respectively.
8624
8625 @quotation Note
8626 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8627 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8628 example.
8629 @end quotation
8630
8631 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8632 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8633 of TCP/IP connections.
8634
8635 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8636 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8637 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8638 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8639 @var{size} bytes.
8640 @end deffn
8641
8642 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8643 Start RTT.
8644 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8645 @end deffn
8646
8647 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8648 Stop RTT.
8649 @end deffn
8650
8651 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8652 Display the polling interval.
8653 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8654 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8655 checked for new data.
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8659 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8660 @end deffn
8661
8662 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8663 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8664 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8665 @end deffn
8666
8667 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8668 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8669 @end deffn
8670
8671 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8672 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8673 @end deffn
8674
8675 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8676 on the target device.
8677
8678 @example
8679 resume
8680
8681 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8682 rtt start
8683
8684 rtt server start 9090 0
8685 @end example
8686
8687 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8688 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8689 TCP/IP port 9090.
8690
8691
8692 @section Misc Commands
8693
8694 @cindex profiling
8695 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8696 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8697 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8698 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8699 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8700 limit the address range.
8701 @end deffn
8702
8703 @deffn {Command} {version}
8704 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8705 @end deffn
8706
8707 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8708 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8709 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8710 @end deffn
8711
8712 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8713 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8714 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8715 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8716
8717 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8718 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8719 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8720 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8721
8722 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8723 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8724 @cindex tracing
8725 @cindex ETM
8726 @cindex ETB
8727
8728 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8729 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8730 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8731
8732 @itemize
8733 @item
8734 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8735 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8736 supports such an interface.
8737 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8738 and trace port support.)
8739 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8740 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8741 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8742 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8743 in the board-specific configuration file.
8744 @item
8745 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8746 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8747 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8748 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8749 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8750 @end itemize
8751
8752 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8753
8754 @quotation Issues
8755 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8756 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8757
8758 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8759 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8760 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8761 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8762 dummy trace port driver}.
8763
8764 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8765 as well as tracing only during specific states
8766 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8767
8768 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8769 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8770 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8771 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8772 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8773
8774 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8775 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8776 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8777 this original style of JTAG access.
8778 @end quotation
8779
8780 @subsection ETM Configuration
8781 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8782
8783 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8784 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8785 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8786
8787 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8788 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8789 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8790 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8791 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8792 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8793 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8794 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8795 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8796
8797 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8798 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8799 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8800
8801 @quotation Warning
8802 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8803 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8804 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8805 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8806 @end quotation
8807
8808 @quotation Note
8809 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8810 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8811 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8812 what CPU activities are traced.
8813 @end quotation
8814 @end deffn
8815
8816 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8817 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8818 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8819 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8820 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8821 @end deffn
8822
8823 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8824 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8825 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8826 Did trace data overflow?
8827 Was it triggered?
8828 @end deffn
8829
8830 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8831 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8832 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8833 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8834 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8835
8836 @itemize
8837 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8838 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8839 The value is one of
8840 @option{none} (save nothing),
8841 @option{data} (save data),
8842 @option{address} (save addresses),
8843 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8844 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8845 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8846 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8847 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8848 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8849 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8850 trace stream without an image of the code.
8851 @end itemize
8852 @end deffn
8853
8854 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8855 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8856 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8857 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8858 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8859
8860 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8861 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8862 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8863 @end deffn
8864
8865 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8866
8867 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8868 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8869 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8870
8871 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8872 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8873 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8874 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8875 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8876 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8877 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8878
8879 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8880
8881 @itemize
8882 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8883 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8884 for instruction access within that function's body.
8885 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8886 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8887 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8888 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8889 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8890 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8891 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8892 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8893 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8894 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8895 @item @emph{... more}
8896 @end itemize
8897
8898 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8899 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8900
8901 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8902 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8903 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8904 @end deffn
8905
8906 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8907 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8908 @end deffn
8909
8910 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8911 Opens an image file.
8912 @end deffn
8913
8914 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8915 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8916 @end deffn
8917
8918 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8919 Starts trace data collection.
8920 @end deffn
8921
8922 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8923 Stops trace data collection.
8924 @end deffn
8925
8926 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8927 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8928
8929 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8930
8931 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8932 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8933 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8934 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8935 any trace data collection.}
8936 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8937 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8938 @end deffn
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8942 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8943 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8944 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8945 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8946 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8947 @end deffn
8948 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8949 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8950 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8951 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8952 trace trigger becomes active.
8953
8954 @itemize
8955 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8956 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8957 afterwards.
8958 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8959 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8960 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8961 what caused that event to happen.
8962 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8963 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8964 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8965 how the event caused trouble.
8966 @end itemize
8967 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @end deffn
8971
8972 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8973 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8974 @cindex CTI
8975
8976 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8977 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8978 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8979 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8980 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8981 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8982
8983 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8984 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8985 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8986 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8987 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8988 including additional configuration.
8989 @end deffn
8990
8991 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8992 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8993 @end deffn
8994
8995 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8996 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8997 @end deffn
8998
8999 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9000 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9001 @end deffn
9002
9003 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9004 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9005 @end deffn
9006
9007 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9008 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9012 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9013 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9017 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9018 of the CTI.
9019 @end deffn
9020
9021 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9022 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9023 useful in TCL scripting.
9024 @end deffn
9025
9026 @section Generic ARM
9027 @cindex ARM
9028
9029 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9030 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9031 commands that may be available.
9032
9033 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9034 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9035 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9036 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9037 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9038 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9042 @cindex disassemble
9043 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9044 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9045 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9046 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9047 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9048 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9049 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9050
9051 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9052 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9053 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9054 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9055 with a handful of exceptions.
9056 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9060 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9061 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9062 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9063 and using the MCR instruction.
9064 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9065 an ARM register.)
9066 @end deffn
9067
9068 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9069 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9070 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9071 and the MRC instruction.
9072 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9073 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9074 an ARM register.)
9075 @end deffn
9076
9077 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9078 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9079 core mode if necessary.
9080 @end deffn
9081
9082 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9083 @cindex ARM semihosting
9084 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9085
9086 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9087 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9088 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9089 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9090 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9091 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9092 @end deffn
9093
9094 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9095 @cindex ARM semihosting
9096 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9097
9098 @example
9099 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9100 @end example
9101
9102 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9103 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9104 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9105 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9106 @end deffn
9107
9108 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9109 @cindex ARM semihosting
9110 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9111 status.
9112
9113 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9114 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9115 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9116 debugger.
9117 @end deffn
9118
9119 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9120 @cindex ARM semihosting
9121 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9122
9123 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9124 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9125 the value returned by the target.
9126
9127 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9128 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9129 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9130 encountering a break.
9131
9132 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9133 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9134 to the debugger.
9135 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9136 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9137 request or equivalent").
9138
9139 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9140 this option (default: disabled).
9141 @end deffn
9142
9143 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9144 @cindex ARMv4
9145 @cindex ARMv5
9146
9147 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9148 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9149 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9150 variant.
9151
9152 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9153 @cindex ARM7
9154 @cindex ARM9
9155
9156 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9157 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9158 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9159 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9160
9161 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9162 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9163 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9164 instead of breakpoints.
9165 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9166
9167 This should be
9168 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9169 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9170 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9171 @end deffn
9172
9173 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9174 @cindex DCC
9175 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9176 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9177 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9178
9179 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9180 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9181 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9185 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9186 that don't check completion of the operation.
9187 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9188
9189 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9190 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9191 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9192 @end deffn
9193
9194 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9195 @cindex ARM9
9196
9197 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9198 integer processors.
9199 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9200
9201 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9202 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9203 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9204 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9205
9206 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9207 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9208 @cindex vector_catch
9209 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9210 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9211 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9212 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9213 to those hardware vectors.
9214
9215 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9216 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9217 vector catch hardware to intercept
9218 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9219 @option{none} of them,
9220 or a list with one or more of the following:
9221 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9222 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9223 @end deffn
9224
9225 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9226 @cindex ARM920T
9227
9228 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9229 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9230 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9231 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9232 and ARM9 commands.
9233
9234 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9235 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9236 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9237 @end deffn
9238
9239 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9240 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9241 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9242 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9243 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9244 (Not all registers can be written.)
9245 @end deffn
9246
9247 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9248 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9249 @end deffn
9250
9251 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9252 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9253 @end deffn
9254
9255 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9256 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9257
9258 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9259 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9260 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9261 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9262 and ARM9 commands.
9263
9264 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9265 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9266
9267 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9268 Print information about the caches found.
9269 @end deffn
9270
9271 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9272 @cindex ARM966E
9273
9274 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9275 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9276 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9277 and ARM9 commands.
9278
9279 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9280 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9281 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9282 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9283 ARM966E-S TRM.
9284 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9285 as required for BIST support.
9286 @end deffn
9287
9288 @subsection XScale specific commands
9289 @cindex XScale
9290
9291 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9292
9293 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9294 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9295 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9296 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9297 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9298 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9299 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9300
9301 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9302 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9303 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9304 the mini-IC.
9305
9306 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9307 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9308 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9309 code layout in memory:
9310 @example
9311 _vectors:
9312 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9313 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9314 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9315 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9316 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9317 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9318 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9319 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9320 .org 0x100
9321 .long real_reset_vector
9322 .long real_ui_handler
9323 .long real_swi_handler
9324 .long real_pf_abort
9325 .long real_data_abort
9326 .long 0 /* unused */
9327 .long real_irq_handler
9328 .long real_fiq_handler
9329 @end example
9330
9331 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9332 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9333 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9334 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9335 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9336 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9337 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9338 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9339 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9340 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9341 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9342 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9343 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9344 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9345 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9346 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9347 software.
9348
9349 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9350 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9351 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9352 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9353
9354 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9355 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9356 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9357 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9358 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9359 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9360 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9361 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9362 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9363
9364 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9365 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9366
9367 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9368 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9369 @end deffn
9370
9371 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9372 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9373 @end deffn
9374
9375 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9376 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9377 @end deffn
9378
9379 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9380 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9381 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9382 @end deffn
9383
9384 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9385 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9386 @end deffn
9387
9388 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9389 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9393 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9394 @end deffn
9395
9396 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9397 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9401 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9402 @end deffn
9403
9404 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9405 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9406 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9407 and modifying how it is emptied.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9411 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9412 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9413 The image @var{type} may be one of
9414 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9415 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9416 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9420 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9421 @cindex vector_catch
9422 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9423 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9424
9425 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9426 @example
9427 0x01 Trap Reset
9428 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9429 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9430 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9431 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9432 0x20 reserved
9433 0x40 Trap IRQ
9434 0x80 Trap FIQ
9435 @end example
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9439 @cindex vector_table
9440
9441 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9442 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9443 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9444 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9445 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9446
9447 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9448
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9452 @cindex ARMv6
9453
9454 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9455 @cindex ARM11
9456
9457 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9458 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9459 which is enabled by default.
9460 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9461 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9462 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9463 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9464 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9465 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9466 @end deffn
9467
9468 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9469 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9470 which is enabled by default.
9471 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9472 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9473 @end deffn
9474
9475 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9476 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9477 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9478 they are disabled by default.
9479 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9480 @end deffn
9481
9482 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9483 @cindex vector_catch
9484 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9485 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9486 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9487
9488 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9489 for certain hardware events.
9490 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9491 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9492 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9493 @end deffn
9494
9495 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9496 @cindex ARMv7
9497 @cindex ARMv8
9498
9499 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9500 @cindex Cortex-A
9501
9502 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9503 display information about target caches
9504 @end deffn
9505
9506 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9507 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9508 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9509 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9510 Defaults to 'off'.
9511 @end deffn
9512
9513 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9514 Initialize core debug
9515 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9516 @end deffn
9517
9518 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9519 Display/set the current SMP mode
9520 @end deffn
9521
9522 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9523 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9524 @end deffn
9525
9526 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9527 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9528 @end deffn
9529
9530 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9531 configure l2x cache
9532 @end deffn
9533
9534 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9535 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9536 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9537 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9538 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9542 @cindex Cortex-R
9543
9544 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9545 Initialize core debug
9546 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9547 @end deffn
9548
9549 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9550 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9551 @end deffn
9552
9553
9554 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9555 @cindex tracing
9556 @cindex SWO
9557 @cindex SWV
9558 @cindex TPIU
9559
9560 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9561 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9562 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9563 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9564
9565 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9566 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9567 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9568 which causes quite some confusion.
9569 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9570 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9571
9572 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9573 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9574 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9575
9576 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9577 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9578 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9579 @end deffn
9580
9581 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9582 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9583 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9584 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9585
9586 @itemize @bullet
9587 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9588 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9589 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9590 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9591
9592 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9593 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9594 @end itemize
9595 @end deffn
9596
9597 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9598 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9599 @end deffn
9600
9601 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9602 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9603 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9604 at any time after the initialization, too.
9605 @end deffn
9606
9607 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9608 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9609 individually queried, to return its current value.
9610 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9611 @end deffn
9612
9613 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9614 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9615 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9616 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9617
9618 @itemize @bullet
9619 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9620 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9621
9622 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9623 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9624
9625 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9626 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9627
9628 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9629 protocol used for trace data:
9630 @itemize @minus
9631 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9632 data bits (default);
9633 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9634 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9635 @end itemize
9636
9637 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9638 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9639 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9640 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9641 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9642 of the TPIU.
9643
9644 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9645 the destination of the trace data:
9646 @itemize @minus
9647 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9648 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9649 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9650 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9651 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9652 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9653 each connected client;
9654 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9655 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9656 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9657 @end itemize
9658
9659 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9660 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9661 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9662 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9663
9664 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9665 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9666 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9667 maximum supported rate automatically.
9668
9669 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9670 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9671 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9672
9673 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9674 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9675 default value is @var{0}.
9676 @end itemize
9677 @end deffn
9678
9679 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9680 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9681 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9682 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9683 data.
9684 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9685 after the @command{init}.
9686 @end deffn
9687
9688 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9689 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9690 @end deffn
9691
9692
9693
9694 Example usage:
9695 @enumerate
9696 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9697 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9698 enough to:
9699 @example
9700 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9701 ...
9702 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9703 ...
9704 @end example
9705 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9706 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9707 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9708 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9709 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9710 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9711 @example
9712 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9713 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9714 @end example
9715 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9716 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9717 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9718 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9719 @example
9720 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9721 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9722 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9723 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9724 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9725 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9726 @end example
9727 @end enumerate
9728
9729 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9730 @cindex tracing
9731 @cindex SWO
9732 @cindex SWV
9733 @cindex ITM
9734 @cindex ETM
9735
9736 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9737 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9738 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9739 @end deffn
9740
9741 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9742 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9743 @end deffn
9744
9745 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9746 @cindex Cortex-M
9747
9748 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9749 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9750
9751 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9752 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9753 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9754 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9755 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9756 the step command leaves with the core running.
9757
9758 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9759 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9760 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9761 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9762
9763 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9764 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9765 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9766 does.
9767
9768 Default is @option{auto}.
9769 @end deffn
9770
9771 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9772 @cindex vector_catch
9773 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9774 for certain hardware events.
9775
9776 Parameters request interception of
9777 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9778 @option{none} of them,
9779 or one or more of the following:
9780 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9781 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9782 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9783 @option{irq_err},
9784 @option{state_err},
9785 @option{chk_err}, or
9786 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9787 @option{reset}.
9788 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9789 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9790 are mapped to HardFault.
9791 UsageFault checks for
9792 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9793 must also be explicitly enabled.
9794
9795 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9796 @end deffn
9797
9798 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9799 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9800 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9801
9802 @itemize @minus
9803 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9804 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9805 @end itemize
9806
9807 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9808 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9809 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9810 to manually reset the peripherals.
9811 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9812
9813 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9814 instead.
9815 @end deffn
9816
9817 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9818 @cindex ARMv8-A
9819 @cindex aarch64
9820
9821 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9822 Display information about target caches
9823 @end deffn
9824
9825 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9826 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9827 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9828 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9829 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9830 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9831 @end deffn
9832
9833 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9834 @cindex disassemble
9835 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9836 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9840 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9841 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9842 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9843 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9844 @end deffn
9845
9846 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9847 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9848 @option{on}.
9849 @end deffn
9850
9851 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9852 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9853 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9854 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9855 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9856 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9857 @end deffn
9858
9859 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9860
9861 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9862 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9863
9864 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9865
9866 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9867 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9868 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9869 @end deffn
9870
9871 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9872 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9873 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9874 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9875 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9876 @end deffn
9877
9878 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9879
9880 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9881 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9882 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9883 @end deffn
9884
9885 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9886
9887 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9888 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9889 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9890 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9891 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9892 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9893 can be collected.
9894
9895 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9896 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9897 tooling.
9898
9899 @quotation Issues
9900 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9901 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9902 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9903 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9904
9905 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9906 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9907 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9908 software operation on the CPU.
9909 @end quotation
9910
9911 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9912 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9913 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9914 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9915 @end deffn
9916
9917 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9918 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9919 @end deffn
9920
9921 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9922 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9923 control is disabled.
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9927 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9928 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9929 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9930
9931 Supported trace formats:
9932 @itemize
9933 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9934 timing to be determined.
9935 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9936 addresses.
9937 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9938 @end itemize
9939 @end deffn
9940
9941 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9942 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9943 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9944 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9945
9946 Supported conditions:
9947 @itemize
9948 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9949 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9950 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9951 instruction matches start data and mask.
9952 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9953 instruction matches start data and mask.
9954 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9955 data and mask.
9956 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9957 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9958 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9959 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9960 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9961 @end itemize
9962 @end deffn
9963
9964 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9965 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9966 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9967 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9968
9969 Supported conditions:
9970 @itemize
9971 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9972 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9973 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9974 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9975 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9976 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9977 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9978 data and mask.
9979 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9980 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9981 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9982 @end itemize
9983 @end deffn
9984
9985 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9986 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9987
9988 Supported triggers:
9989 @itemize
9990 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9991 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9992 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9993 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9994 collection.
9995 @end itemize
9996 @end deffn
9997
9998 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9999
10000 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10001 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10002 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10003 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10004 @end deffn
10005
10006 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10007 Display trace configuration.
10008 @end deffn
10009
10010 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10011 Display trace collection status.
10012 @end deffn
10013
10014 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10015 Start manual trace collection.
10016 @end deffn
10017
10018 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10019 Stop manual trace collection.
10020 @end deffn
10021
10022 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10023 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10024 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10025 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10026 @option{size} options using DMA.
10027 @end deffn
10028
10029 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10030 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10031 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10032 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10033 @option{size} options using DMA.
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @section Intel Architecture
10037
10038 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10039 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10040 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10041 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10042 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10043 @itemize
10044 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10045 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10046 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10047 @end itemize
10048
10049 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10050 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10051 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10052
10053 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10054 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10055 @end deffn
10056
10057 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10058 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10059 @end deffn
10060
10061 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10062 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10063 @end deffn
10064
10065 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10066 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10067 @end deffn
10068
10069 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10070 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10071 @end deffn
10072
10073 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10074 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10075 @end deffn
10076
10077 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10078
10079 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10080 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10081
10082 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10083 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10084 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10085 @end deffn
10086 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10087 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10088
10089 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10090
10091 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10092 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10093 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10094 @end deffn
10095
10096 @subsection Registers commands
10097 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10098 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10099 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10100
10101 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10102
10103 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10104 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10105 and "timer" groups.
10106
10107 @emph{example:}
10108 @example
10109 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10110 @end example
10111
10112 @end deffn
10113
10114 @section RISC-V Architecture
10115
10116 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10117 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10118 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10119 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10120 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10121 implement version 0.11.
10122
10123 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10124
10125 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10126 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10127 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10128
10129 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10130
10131 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10132 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10133 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10134
10135 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10136 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10137 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10138 CSRs.
10139 @end deffn
10140
10141 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10142 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10143 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10144 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10145 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10146 This command must be executed before `init`.
10147 @end deffn
10148
10149 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10150 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10151 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10152 @end deffn
10153
10154 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10155 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10156 deasserted.
10157 @end deffn
10158
10159 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10160 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10161 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10162 @end deffn
10163
10164 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10165 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10166 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10167 on physical memory.
10168 @end deffn
10169
10170 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10171 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10172 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10173 performed on physical memory.
10174 @end deffn
10175
10176 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10177 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10178 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10179 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10180 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10181 race condition problem in your code.
10182
10183 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10184 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10185 @end deffn
10186
10187 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10188 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10189 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10190 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10191 values.
10192
10193 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10194 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10195 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10196 @end deffn
10197
10198 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10199 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10200 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10201 @end deffn
10202
10203 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10204 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10205 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10206 @end deffn
10207
10208 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10209 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10210 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10211 @end deffn
10212
10213 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10214 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10215 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10216 @end deffn
10217
10218 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10219
10220 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10221 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10222 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10223 @example
10224 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10225 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10226 @end example
10227
10228 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10229 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10230 @end deffn
10231
10232 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10233 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10234 @end deffn
10235
10236 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10237
10238 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10239 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10240
10241 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10242 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10243 @end deffn
10244
10245 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10246 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10247 @end deffn
10248
10249 @section ARC Architecture
10250 @cindex ARC
10251
10252 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10253 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10254 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10255 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10256 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10257 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10258 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10259 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10260 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10261 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10262 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10263 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10264 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10265 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10266 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10267
10268
10269 @subsection General ARC commands
10270
10271 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10272
10273 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10274 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10275 arguments:
10276
10277 @itemize @bullet
10278
10279 @item @code{-name} name
10280 @*Name of a register.
10281
10282 @item @code{-num} number
10283 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10284
10285 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10286 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10287
10288 @end itemize
10289
10290 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10291
10292 @itemize @bullet
10293
10294 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10295 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10296 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10297 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10298 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10299 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10300
10301 @item @code{-core}
10302 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10303 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10304 spaces.
10305
10306 @item @code{-bcr}
10307 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10308 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10309 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10310 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10311 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10312
10313 @item @code{-type} type_name
10314 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10315 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10316
10317 @item @code{-g}
10318 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10319 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10320 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10321 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10322 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10323
10324 @end itemize
10325
10326 @end deffn
10327
10328 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10329 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10330 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10331 @end deffn
10332
10333 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10334 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10335 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10336 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10337 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10338 startbit endbit}.
10339 @end deffn
10340
10341 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10342 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10343 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10344 @end deffn
10345
10346 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10347 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10348 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10349 @end deffn
10350
10351 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10352
10353 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10354 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10355 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10356 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10357
10358 @end deffn
10359
10360 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10361 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10362 registers.
10363 @end deffn
10364
10365 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10366 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10367 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10368 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10369
10370 @end deffn
10371
10372 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10373 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10374 registers.
10375 @end deffn
10376
10377 @section STM8 Architecture
10378 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10379 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10380
10381 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10382 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10383
10384 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10385 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10386 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10387 @cindex tracing
10388 @cindex libdcc
10389 @cindex DCC
10390 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10391 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10392 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10393 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10394
10395 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10396 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10397 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10398 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10399 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10400 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10401
10402 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10403 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10404 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10405 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10406 The target being debugged may
10407 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10408 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10409 each supported by a command:
10410
10411 @itemize
10412 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10413 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10414 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10415 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10416
10417 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10418 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10419 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10420
10421 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10422 and then displayed at any time.
10423 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10424
10425 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10426 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10427 @end itemize
10428
10429 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10430 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10431 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10432 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10433 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10434 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10435 does the same thing.
10436
10437 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10438 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10439 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10440 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10441 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10442
10443 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10444 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10445 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10446 @end deffn
10447
10448 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10449 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10450 in the order they triggered.
10451 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10452 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10453 history records.
10454 @end deffn
10455
10456 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10457 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10458 they have been triggered.
10459 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10460 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10461 and associates it with that identifier.
10462
10463 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10464 are not related except by this command.
10465 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10466 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10467 @end deffn
10468
10469
10470 @node JTAG Commands
10471 @chapter JTAG Commands
10472 @cindex JTAG Commands
10473 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10474 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10475 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10476 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10477 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10478
10479 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10480 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10481
10482 @itemize @bullet
10483 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10484 devices such as a CPUs.
10485 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10486 standard state machine (in parallel)
10487 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10488 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10489 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10490 while the reading previous ones.
10491 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10492 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10493 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10494 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10495 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10496 registers.
10497 @end itemize
10498
10499 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10500
10501 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10502 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10503 the order of TAP state transitions.
10504 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10505 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10506 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10507 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10508 these commands are not available.
10509
10510 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10511 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10512 that specify the entire register.
10513 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10514 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10515 The return value holds the original value of each
10516 of those fields.
10517
10518 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10519 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10520 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10521 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10522 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10523
10524 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10525 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10526
10527 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10528 in that state.
10529 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10530 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10531 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10532
10533 @quotation Warning
10534 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10535 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10536 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10537 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10538 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10539 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10540 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10541 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10542 @end quotation
10543 @end deffn
10544
10545 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10546 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10547 This may be used for performance tuning.
10548
10549 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10550 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10551 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10552 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10553 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10554 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10555 @end deffn
10556
10557 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10558 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10559 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10560 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10561 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10562 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10563
10564 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10565 in that state.
10566 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10567 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10568 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10569
10570 @quotation Note
10571 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10572 register values, unlike data register values.
10573 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10574 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10575 @end quotation
10576 @end deffn
10577
10578 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10579 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10580 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10581 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10582 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10583 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10584 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10585 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10586 The final state must also be stable.
10587 @end deffn
10588
10589 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10590 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10591 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10592 Instructions often need some time
10593 to execute before they take effect.
10594 @end deffn
10595
10596 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10597 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10598
10599 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10600 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10601 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10602 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10603 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10604 @end deffn
10605
10606 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10607 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10608 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10609 must also be enabled.
10610 Default is enabled.
10611 @end deffn
10612
10613 @section TAP state names
10614 @cindex TAP state names
10615
10616 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10617 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10618 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10619 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10620
10621 @itemize @bullet
10622 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10623 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10624 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10625 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10626 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10627 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10628 through the data register
10629 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10630 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10631 for update or more shifting
10632 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10633 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10634 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10635 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10636 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10637 through the instruction register
10638 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10639 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10640 for update or more shifting
10641 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10642 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10643 @end itemize
10644
10645 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10646 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10647 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10648 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10649
10650 @itemize @bullet
10651 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10652 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10653 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10654 may not be as expected.
10655 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10656 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10657 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10658 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10659 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10660 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10661 @end itemize
10662
10663 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10664 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10665
10666 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10667 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10668 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10669 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10670
10671 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10672 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10673 @cindex SVF
10674
10675 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10676 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10677 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10678 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10679
10680 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10681 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10682 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10683 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10684
10685 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10686 affect their semantics.
10687
10688 Command options:
10689 @itemize @minus
10690 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10691 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10692 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10693 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10694 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10695 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10696 on the real interface;
10697 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10698 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10699 errors.
10700 @end itemize
10701 @end deffn
10702
10703 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10704 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10705 @cindex XSVF
10706
10707 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10708 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10709 Xilinx devices.
10710 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10711 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10712
10713 @quotation Important
10714 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10715 @end quotation
10716
10717 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10718 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10719 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10720 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10721 that TAP.
10722 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10723 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10724 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10725 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10726 @end deffn
10727
10728 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10729 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10730 after building the software.
10731 You may find them useful:
10732
10733 @itemize
10734 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10735 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10736 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10737 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10738 @end itemize
10739
10740 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10741 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10742 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10743 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10744 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10745 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10746 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10747
10748
10749 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10750 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10751 @cindex IPDBG
10752
10753 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10754 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10755 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10756 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10757 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10758 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10759
10760 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10761 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10762
10763 Command options:
10764 @itemize @bullet
10765 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10766 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10767 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10768 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10769 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10770 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10771 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10772 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10773 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10774 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10775 shift data through vir can be configured.
10776 @end itemize
10777 @end deffn
10778
10779 Examples:
10780 @example
10781 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10782 @end example
10783 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10784 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10785
10786 @example
10787 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10788 @end example
10789 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10790 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10791
10792 @node Utility Commands
10793 @chapter Utility Commands
10794 @cindex Utility Commands
10795
10796 @section RAM testing
10797 @cindex RAM testing
10798
10799 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10800 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10801 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10802 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10803 hardware problems.
10804
10805 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10806 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10807 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10808 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10809
10810 Load the memory testing functions with
10811
10812 @example
10813 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10814 @end example
10815
10816 to get access to the following facilities:
10817
10818 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10819 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10820 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10821 @end deffn
10822
10823 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10824 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10825 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10826 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10827 @end deffn
10828
10829 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10830 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10831 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10832 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10833 @end deffn
10834
10835 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10836 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10837 @end deffn
10838
10839 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10840 @cindex Firmware recovery
10841
10842 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10843 devices recovery with JTAG.
10844
10845 For quickstart instructions run:
10846 @example
10847 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10848 @end example
10849
10850 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10851 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10852 @cindex GDB
10853 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10854 to debug remote targets.
10855 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10856
10857 @itemize
10858 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10859 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10860 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10861 as shown in this chapter.
10862 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10863 that also will probably need to be configured.
10864 @end itemize
10865
10866 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10867 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10868 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10869 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10870 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10871 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10872
10873 @section Connecting to GDB
10874 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10875 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10876 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10877 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10878 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10879
10880 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10881
10882 @enumerate
10883 @item
10884 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10885 @example
10886 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10887 @end example
10888 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10889
10890 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10891 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10892 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10893
10894 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10895 remote command above that becomes:
10896 @example
10897 tar ext :3333
10898 @end example
10899
10900 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10901 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10902 available through the command:
10903 @example
10904 target remote localhost:3333
10905 @end example
10906
10907 @item
10908 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10909 @example
10910 target extended-remote | \
10911 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10912 @end example
10913 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10914 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10915 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10916 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10917 @end enumerate
10918
10919 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10920 GDB command line.
10921
10922 @section Sample GDB session startup
10923
10924 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10925 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10926 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10927 small ARM program.
10928 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10929 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10930
10931 @example
10932 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10933 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10934 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10935 ...
10936 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10937 ...
10938 (gdb) load
10939 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10940 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10941 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10942 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10943 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10944 (gdb) continue
10945 Continuing.
10946 ...
10947 @end example
10948
10949 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10950 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10951 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10952 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10953
10954 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10955
10956 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10957 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10958 packet size and the device's memory map.
10959 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10960 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10961 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10962
10963 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10964 You may need to set those up by hand.
10965 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10966 something like:
10967
10968 @example
10969 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10970 @end example
10971
10972 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10973
10974 @example
10975 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10976 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10977 @end example
10978
10979 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10980 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10981 do not have such restrictions.
10982
10983 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10984 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10985 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10986 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10987
10988 @section Programming using GDB
10989 @cindex Programming using GDB
10990 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10991
10992 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10993 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10994 @example
10995 gdb_memory_map disable
10996 @end example
10997 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10998 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10999 working area.
11000
11001 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11002 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11003 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11004 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11005
11006 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11007 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11008
11009 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11010 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11011 @example
11012 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11013 @end example
11014
11015 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11016 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11017
11018 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11019 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11020 will be used.
11021
11022 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11023 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11024 @example
11025 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11026 @end example
11027 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11028
11029 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11030 can be used.
11031
11032 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11033 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11034 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11035
11036 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11037 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11038 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11039
11040 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11041 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11042 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11043 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11044 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11045 without any intrusion of the target process.
11046
11047 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11048 Place following command after target configuration:
11049 @example
11050 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11051 @end example
11052
11053 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11054 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11055 @example
11056 gdb_memory_map disable
11057 @end example
11058
11059 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11060 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11061 @example
11062 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11063 @end example
11064
11065 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11066 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11067
11068 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11069 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11070 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11071 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11072
11073 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11074 previously shown variables.
11075
11076 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11077 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11078 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11079 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11080 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11081
11082 @section RTOS Support
11083 @cindex RTOS Support
11084 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11085
11086 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11087 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11088
11089 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11090 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11091 GDB commands.
11092
11093 @* An example setup is below:
11094
11095 @example
11096 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11097 @end example
11098
11099 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11100
11101 Currently supported rtos's include:
11102 @itemize @bullet
11103 @item @option{eCos}
11104 @item @option{ThreadX}
11105 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11106 @item @option{linux}
11107 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11108 @item @option{embKernel}
11109 @item @option{mqx}
11110 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11111 @item @option{nuttx}
11112 @item @option{RIOT}
11113 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11114 @item @option{Zephyr}
11115 @end itemize
11116
11117 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11118 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11119
11120 @table @code
11121 @item eCos symbols
11122 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11123 @item ThreadX symbols
11124 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11125 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11126 @raggedright
11127 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11128 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11129 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11130 @end raggedright
11131 @item linux symbols
11132 init_task.
11133 @item ChibiOS symbols
11134 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11135 @item embKernel symbols
11136 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11137 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11138 @item mqx symbols
11139 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11140 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11141 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11142 @item nuttx symbols
11143 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11144 @item RIOT symbols
11145 @raggedright
11146 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11147 _tcb_name_offset.
11148 @end raggedright
11149 @item Zephyr symbols
11150 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11151 @end table
11152
11153 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11154 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11155
11156 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11157 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11158
11159 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11160 along with the project:
11161
11162 @table @code
11163 @item FreeRTOS
11164 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11165 @item uC/OS-III
11166 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11167 @end table
11168
11169 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11170 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11171 @cindex SMP
11172 @cindex RTOS
11173 @cindex hwthread
11174 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11175 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11176 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11177 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11178 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11179 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11180 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11181 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11182 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11183
11184 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11185 @quotation Note
11186 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11187 @end quotation
11188
11189 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11190 @itemize @bullet
11191 @item j - smp status request
11192 @item J - smp set request
11193 @end itemize
11194
11195 OpenOCD implements :
11196 @itemize @bullet
11197 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11198 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11199 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11200 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11201 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11202 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11203 @end itemize
11204
11205 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11206 @itemize @bullet
11207 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11208 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11209 @example
11210 set $_core 1
11211 #Jc01 packet is sent
11212 print $_core
11213 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11214 @end example
11215
11216 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11217 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11218
11219 @example
11220 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11221 define toggle0
11222 maint packet Jc0
11223 continue
11224 main packet Jc-1
11225 end
11226 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11227 define toggle1
11228 maint packet Jc1
11229 continue
11230 main packet Jc-1
11231 end
11232 @end example
11233 @end itemize
11234
11235 @node Tcl Scripting API
11236 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11237 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11238 @cindex Tcl scripts
11239 @section API rules
11240
11241 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11242 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11243 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11244
11245 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11246 pair list and lists.
11247
11248 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11249 list.
11250
11251 @example
11252 > set foo(me) Duane
11253 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11254 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11255 > set foo(duck) Donald
11256 @end example
11257
11258 If one does this:
11259
11260 @example
11261 > set foo
11262 @end example
11263
11264 The result is:
11265
11266 @example
11267 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11268 @end example
11269
11270 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11271
11272 @verbatim
11273 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11274 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11275 }
11276 @end verbatim
11277
11278 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11279 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11280
11281 @section Internal low-level Commands
11282
11283 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11284 invoke directly.
11285
11286 @itemize @bullet
11287 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11288
11289 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11290 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11291
11292 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11293 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11294
11295 Return information about the flash banks
11296
11297 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11298
11299 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11300 its execution. Example:
11301
11302 @example
11303 > capture "reset init"
11304 @end example
11305
11306 @end itemize
11307
11308 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11309 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11310 called "flash_banks".
11311
11312 @section Tcl RPC server
11313 @cindex RPC
11314
11315 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11316 commands and receive the results.
11317
11318 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11319 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11320 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11321 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11322 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11323
11324 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11325 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11326 @command{capture} command.
11327
11328 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11329
11330 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11331 @cindex RPC Notifications
11332
11333 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11334 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11335
11336 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11337 in the following format.
11338
11339 @verbatim
11340 type target_event event [event-name]
11341 type target_state state [state-name]
11342 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11343 @end verbatim
11344
11345 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11346 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11347 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11348 Defaults to off.
11349
11350 @end deffn
11351
11352 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11353 @cindex RPC trace output
11354
11355 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11356 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11357
11358 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11359
11360 @verbatim
11361 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11362 @end verbatim
11363
11364 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11365 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11366 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11367 Defaults to off.
11368
11369 See an example application here:
11370 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11371
11372 @end deffn
11373
11374 @node FAQ
11375 @chapter FAQ
11376 @cindex faq
11377 @enumerate
11378 @anchor{faqrtck}
11379 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11380 @cindex RTCK
11381 @cindex adaptive clocking
11382 @*
11383
11384 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11385 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11386 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11387 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11388
11389 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11390 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11391 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11392 @enumerate
11393 @item
11394 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11395 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11396 @item
11397 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11398 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11399 @end enumerate
11400
11401 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11402 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11403 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11404 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11405 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11406 power).
11407
11408 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11409 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11410 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11411 ARM926 scenario).
11412 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11413 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11414 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11415
11416 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11417 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11418 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11419 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11420
11421 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11422
11423 In order to make use of this,
11424 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11425 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11426
11427 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11428 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11429 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11430 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11431 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11432
11433 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11434 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11435 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11436 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11437
11438 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11439 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11440 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11441 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11442 with a CPLD.
11443 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11444 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11445 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11446 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11447 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11448 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11449
11450 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11451
11452 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11453
11454 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11455 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11456 depending on the chips on your board.
11457 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11458 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11459 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11460
11461 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11462 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11463 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11464
11465 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11466 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11467 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11468 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11469
11470 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11471 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11472 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11473 this way.
11474
11475 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11476 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11477 clock rate.
11478 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11479 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11480 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11481
11482 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11483
11484 @example
11485 # Example: 1.234MHz
11486 adapter speed 1234
11487 @end example
11488
11489
11490 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11491
11492 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11493 around Windows filenames.
11494
11495 @example
11496 > echo \a
11497
11498 > echo @{\a@}
11499 \a
11500 > echo "\a"
11501
11502 >
11503 @end example
11504
11505
11506 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11507
11508 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11509 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11510 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11511
11512 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11513 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11514 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11515
11516 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11517 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11518 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11519
11520 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11521
11522 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11523 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11524 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11525 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11526
11527 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11528 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11529 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11530
11531 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11532 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11533
11534 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11535 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11536 memory read caused data abort".
11537
11538 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11539 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11540 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11541 be done, feel free to add this here.
11542
11543 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11544 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11545 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11546 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11547 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11548 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11549 gracefully stops.
11550
11551 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11552 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11553 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11554
11555 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11556 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11557 bytes. Painful...
11558
11559
11560 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11561 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11562
11563 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11564 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11565 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11566 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11567 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11568 reset, everything else should work fine.
11569
11570 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11571 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11572 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11573 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11574
11575 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11576 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11577 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11578 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11579
11580 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11581
11582 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11583 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11584 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11585
11586 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11587 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11588
11589 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11590 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11591 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11592 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11593 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11594 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11595 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11596 clock frequency?
11597
11598 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11599 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11600 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11601 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11602 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11603
11604 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11605
11606 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11607 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11608 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11609 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11610 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11611 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11612 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11613
11614 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11615
11616 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11617 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11618 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11619 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11620
11621 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11622 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11623 particular order?
11624
11625 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11626 the same order used by the hardware.
11627
11628 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11629 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11630 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11631 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11632 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11633 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11634
11635 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11636 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11637 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11638 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11639
11640 @itemize @bullet
11641 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11642 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11643 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11644 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11645 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11646 @end itemize
11647
11648 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11649
11650 @itemize @bullet
11651 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11652 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11653 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11654 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11655 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11656 @end itemize
11657
11658
11659 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11660 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11661 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11662
11663 TODO.
11664
11665 @end enumerate
11666
11667 @node Tcl Crash Course
11668 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11669 @cindex Tcl
11670
11671 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11672 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11673 how the Tcl scripts work.
11674
11675 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11676 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11677 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11678 OpenOCD.
11679
11680 @section Tcl Rule #1
11681 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11682 @enumerate
11683 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11684 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11685 @end enumerate
11686
11687 The Tcl equal is this:
11688
11689 @enumerate
11690 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11691 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11692 @end enumerate
11693
11694 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11695 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11696
11697 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11698 There is a second pair of rules.
11699 @enumerate
11700 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11701 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11702 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11703 in Tcl.
11704 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11705 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11706 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11707 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11708 @end enumerate
11709
11710 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11711 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11712 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11713 Everything is a string}
11714
11715 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11716 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11717 difference is subtle.
11718 @enumerate
11719 @item Parse Time
11720 @item Evaluation Time
11721 @end enumerate
11722
11723 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11724 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11725 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11726
11727 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11728 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11729 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11730 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11731
11732 @itemize @bullet
11733 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11734 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11735 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11736 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11737 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11738 @example
11739 # bash example
11740 X=`date`
11741 echo "The Date is: $X"
11742 # Tcl example
11743 set X [date]
11744 puts "The Date is: $X"
11745 @end example
11746 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11747 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11748 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11749 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11750 is a string}
11751 @example
11752 set x "Dinner"
11753 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11754 @end example
11755 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11756 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11757 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11758 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11759 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11760 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11761 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11762 @end itemize
11763
11764 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11765
11766 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11767
11768 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11769
11770 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11771 the normal way.
11772
11773 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11774 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11775 line is immediately executed.
11776
11777 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11778 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11779
11780 @subsection Command Execution
11781
11782 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11783 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11784 control flow operators.
11785
11786 Commands are executed like this:
11787
11788 @enumerate
11789 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11790 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11791 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11792 @end enumerate
11793
11794 It sort of works like this:
11795 @example
11796 for(;;)@{
11797 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11798
11799 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11800
11801 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11802 @}
11803 @end example
11804
11805 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11806 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11807 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11808 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11809 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11810 ``LookupCommand()''
11811
11812 @subsection The FOR command
11813
11814 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11815 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11816 command just like any other command.
11817
11818 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11819 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11820 are:
11821
11822 @enumerate 0
11823 @item The ascii text 'for'
11824 @item The start text
11825 @item The test expression
11826 @item The next text
11827 @item The body text
11828 @end enumerate
11829
11830 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11831 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11832 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11833 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11834
11835 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11836 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11837
11838 @example
11839 int
11840 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11841 int *argc,
11842 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11843 @end example
11844
11845 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11846 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11847 still operates in the same basic way.
11848
11849 @subsection FOR command implementation
11850
11851 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11852 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11853
11854 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11855
11856 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11857
11858 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11859 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11860 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11861
11862 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11863 expression and returns a value.
11864
11865 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11866 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11867 @example
11868 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11869
11870 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11871
11872 int
11873 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11874 int argc,
11875 char **argv )
11876 @{
11877 if( argc != 5 )@{
11878 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11879 return ERROR;
11880 @}
11881
11882 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11883
11884 // Execute the start statement.
11885 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11886
11887 // Top of loop test
11888 for(;;)@{
11889 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11890 if( i == 0 )
11891 break;
11892
11893 // Execute the body
11894 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11895
11896 // Execute the LOOP part
11897 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11898 @}
11899
11900 // Return no error
11901 SetResult( interp, "" );
11902 return SUCCESS;
11903 @}
11904 @end example
11905
11906 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11907 in the same basic way.
11908
11909 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11910
11911 @subsection source and find commands
11912 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11913 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11914 @*Remember the parsing rules
11915 @enumerate
11916 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11917 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11918 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11919 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11920 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11921 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11922 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11923 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11924 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11925 @end enumerate
11926 @subsection format command
11927 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11928 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11929 @b{sprintf()}.
11930 @b{Example}
11931 @example
11932 set x 6
11933 set y 7
11934 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11935 @end example
11936 @enumerate
11937 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11938 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11939 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11940 @* Refer to Rule #1
11941 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11942 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11943 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11944 @end enumerate
11945 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11946 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11947 @example
11948 #1 Good
11949 proc someproc @{@} @{
11950 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11951 @}
11952 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11953 #2 Good - no variables
11954 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11955 #3 Good Curly Braces
11956 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11957 puts "Time: [date]"
11958 @}
11959 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11960 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11961 @end example
11962 @enumerate
11963 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11964 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11965 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11966 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11967 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11968 command.
11969 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11970 @*There are 4 examples:
11971 @enumerate
11972 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11973 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11974 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11975 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11976 @end enumerate
11977
11978 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11979 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11980 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11981
11982 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11983 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11984 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11985 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11986 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11987 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11988 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11989 @end enumerate
11990 @subsection Global Variables
11991 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11992 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11993 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11994 @example
11995 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11996 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11997 global x #Global variable X
11998 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11999 @}
12000 @end example
12001 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12002 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12003 @example
12004 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12005 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12006 # Create var name
12007 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12008 # Make it a global
12009 global $vn
12010 # Set it.
12011 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12012 @}
12013 @end example
12014 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12015 @example
12016 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12017 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12018 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12019 @}
12020 @end example
12021
12022 @node License
12023 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12024 @include fdl.texi
12025
12026 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12027 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12028 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12029 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12030 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12031 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12032
12033 @printindex cp
12034
12035 @node Command and Driver Index
12036 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12037 @printindex fn
12038
12039 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)